Commit graph

2392 commits

Author SHA1 Message Date
Jouni Malinen
16a4e931f0 OWE: Allow Diffie-Hellman Parameter element to be included with DPP
The previous OWE implementation on the AP side rejected any
(Re)Association Request frame with the Diffie-Hellman Parameter element
if AKM was not OWE. This breaks compatibility with DPP PFS, so relax
that rule to allow DPP AKM to be used as well. While this commit alone
does not add support for PFS, this allows interoperability between
non-PFS implementation on the AP and a newer PFS implementation on the
STA.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-18 00:27:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9305c2332b DPP: Clean up configuration parsing
Share a single parsing implementation for both hostapd and
wpa_supplicant to avoid code duplication. In addition, clean up the
implementation to be more easily extensible.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-16 17:29:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff5f54e159 SAE: Reduce queue wait time for pending Authentication frames
The queue_len * 50 ms wait time was too large with the retransmission
timeouts used in the mesh case for SAE. The maximum wait of 750 ms was
enough to prevent successful completion of authentication after having
hit the maximum queue length. While the previous commit is enough to
allow this to complete successfully in couple of retries, it looks like
a smaller wait time should be used here even if it means potentially
using more CPU.

Drop the processing wait time to queue_len * 10 ms so that the maximum
wait time is 150 ms if the queue is full.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-15 00:31:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5e3a759cd4 SAE: Improved queuing policy for pending authentication frames
The previous design of simply queuing all SAE commit messages was not
exactly good at allowing recovery from a flooding state if the valid
peer used frequent retransmissions of the SAE message. This could
happen, e.g., with mesh BSSs using SAE. The frequent retransmissions and
restarts of SAE authentication combined with SAE confirm messages
bypassing the queue ended up in not being able to finish SAE exchange
successfully.

Fix this by modifying the queuing policy to queue SAE confirm messages
if there is a queued SAE commit message from the same peer so that the
messages within the same exchange do not get reordered. In addition,
replace queued SAE commit/confirm message if a new matching message is
received from the same peer STA. This is useful for the case where the
peer restarts SAE more quickly than the local end has time to process
the queued messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-15 00:31:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
67b3bcc954 DPP2: Testing option for Config Object rejction
Add a new testing option to force Enrollee to reject the receive Config
Object.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-15 00:31:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
22f90b32f1 DPP2: Configuration Result message generation and processing
Use this new message from Enrollee to Configurator to indicate result of
the config object provisioning if both devices support protocol version
2 or newer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-15 00:31:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3653663933 FILS+FT: AP mode processing of PMKR1Name in initial MD association
Derive PMKR1Name during the FILS authentication step, verify that the
station uses matching PMKR1Name in (Re)Association Request frame, and
add RSNE[PMKR1Name] into (Re)Association Response frame when going
through FT initial mobility domain association using FILS. These steps
were missed from the initial implementation, but are needed to match the
IEEE 802.11ai requirements for explicit confirmation of the FT key
hierarchy (similarly to what is done in FT 4-way handshake when FILS is
not used).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-13 19:15:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aabbdb818d FILS: Do not try to add PMKSA cache entry if caching is disabled
This gets rid of a confusing error message "FILS: Failed to add PMKSA
cache entry based on ERP" for cases where PMKSA caching is disabled in
hostapd (disable_pmksa_caching=1). Functionality remains unchanged,
i.e., no cache entry was added before this change either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-13 16:34:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bf0021ede3 Allow fragmentation/RTS threshold to be disabled explicitly
hostapd configuration parameters fragm_threshold and rts_threshold were
documented to disable the threshold with value -1 and not change driver
configuration if the parameter is not included. However, -1 was mapped
into not changing the driver value, so the explicit disabling part did
not work.

Replace the default values for these to be -2 so that explicitly set
configuration value -1 can be distinguished from the case of not
including the parameter. Map the -1 value to a driver request to disable
the threshold. Ignore any error from this operation just in case to
avoid breaking functionality should some drivers not accept the (u32) -1
value as a threshold value request to disable the mechanism.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-12 17:15:08 +02:00
Jared Bents
841205a1ce OpenSSL: Add 'check_cert_subject' support for TLS server
This patch added 'check_cert_subject' support to match the value of
every field against the DN of the subject in the client certificate. If
the values do not match, the certificate verification will fail and will
reject the user.

This option allows hostapd to match every individual field in the right
order, also allow '*' character as a wildcard (e.g OU=Development*).

Note: hostapd will match string up to 'wildcard' against the DN of the
subject in the client certificate for every individual field.

Signed-off-by: Paresh Chaudhary <paresh.chaudhary@rockwellcollins.com>
Signed-off-by: Jared Bents <jared.bents@rockwellcollins.com>
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-03-11 14:09:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4d379be4a9 Clarify AP mode Action frame handling
Include only one of hostapd_mgmt_rx() and hostapd_action_rx() functions
in the build. Previously, NEED_AP_MLME builds (i.e., cases where hostapd
AP MLME implementation is included) included both of these functions and
both were tried in sequence. In addition to being difficult to
understand, that could result in unexpected behavior if
hostapd_mgmt_rx() rejected a frame and return 0 to allow
hostapd_action_rx() to attempt to process the frame.

All the operations included in hostapd_action_rx() are supposed to be
available through the hostapd_mgmt_rx() call in handle_action() and
those should result in the exact same Category/Action-based handler
function to be called in the end. As such, this should not result in
different behavior. And if there is a difference, that would be pointing
at a hidden bug that would need to be fixed anyway. Furthermore, builds
without NEED_AP_MLME would not have any difference in behavior or
contents of the binary either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-03-09 12:51:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cc833a236c Minor cleanup to return after WNM Action frame handling
There is no need to go through the following handler calls in
hostapd_action_rx() after having found the matching WLAN_ACTION_WNM
handler.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-03-09 12:43:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
700b3f395e Move SA Query frame length check to the shared handler function
Check the length in the common handler functions instead of both
callers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-03-09 12:41:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
002edb6303 Fix AP MLME in driver handling of FT and SA Query Action frames
hostapd_action_rx() was pointing at incorrect field (Action vs.
Category) for the wpa_ft_action_rx() call and the length check for SA
Query Action frames. This resulted in those frames getting dropped as
invalid (FT) or ignored as truncated (SA Query). Fix this by pointing to
the correct place at the beginning of the frame body.

This issue had a long history. These were broken during cleanup in
commit dbfb8e82ff ("Remove unnecessary EVENT_RX_ACTION") which
actually fixed the initial reason for the error accidentally. It was
just that that error was needed to cancel out another earlier error..

One of the errors came from misuse of the EVENT_RX_ACTION API in commit
deca6eff74 ("atheros: Add new IEEE 802.11r driver_ops"). That pointed
struct rx_action data/len to cover the Action frame from the Category
field to the end of the frame body while the API was documented to cover
Action field to the end of the frame body. This error was cancelled by
another error in commit 88b32a99d3 ("FT: Add FT AP support for drivers
that manage MLME internally") that called wpa_ft_action_rx() with the
struct rx_action::data field as the second argument. That argument needs
to point to the Category field, but that struct rx_action field was
supposed to point to the Action field.

Number of the Action frame handlers added into hostapd_action_rx() had
been fixed more or less accidentally after this in various other
commits, but the FT and SA Query handlers had ended up maintaining the
incorrect operations. This is now fixing those.

This seems to fix at least some cases of FT-over-DS with drivers that
use driver-based AP MLME. Such drivers might use internal SA Query
processing, so it is not clear whether that part actually fixes any real
issues.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-03-09 12:41:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
96d6dfa8e4 SAE: Add Finite Cyclic Group field in status code 77 response
Copy the Finite Cyclic Group field value from the request to the
response Authentication frame if we end up rejecting the request due to
unsupported group.

IEEE Std 802.11-2016 has conflicting statements about this behavior.
Table 9-36 (Presence of fields and elements in Authentication frames)
indicates that the Finite Cyclic Group field is only included with
status code values 0 (success) and 76 (anti-clogging token request)
while SAE protocol description implying that the Finite Cyclic Group
field is set to the rejected group (12.4.8.6.3 and 12.4.8.6.4).

The standard language needs to cleaned up to describe this
unambiguously, but since it looks safe to add the field into the
rejection case and since there is desire to have the field present to be
able to implement what exactly is stated in 12.4.8.6.4, it looks
reasonable to move ahead with the AP mode implementation change. There
is no change in wpa_supplicant for now to modify its behavior based on
whether this field is present, i.e., wpa_supplicant will continue to
work with both the old and new hostapd behavior for SAE group
negotiation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-08 16:21:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fc30f99b34 WPS: Allow AP SAE configuration to be added automatically for PSK
The new hostapd configuration parameter wps_cred_add_sae=1 can be used
to request hostapd to add SAE configuration whenever WPS is used to
configure the AP to use WPA2-PSK and the credential includes a
passphrase (instead of PSK). This can be used to enable WPA3-Personal
transition mode with both SAE and PSK enabled and PMF enabled for PSK
and required for SAE associations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-06 21:52:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f214361581 SAE: Reuse previously generated PWE on a retry with the same STA
Do not start SAE authentication from scratch if a STA starts a new
attempt for the same group while we still have previously generated PWE
available. Instead, use the previously generated PWE as-is and skip
anti-clogging token exchange since the heavy processing is already
completed. This saves unnecessary processing on the AP side in case the
STA failed to complete authentication on the first attempt (e.g., due to
heavy SAE load on the AP causing a timeout) and makes it more likely for
a valid STA to be able to complete SAE authentication during a DoS
attack.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-06 13:07:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a9af1da0b5 SAE: Enforce single use for anti-clogging tokens
Add a 16-bit token index into the anti-clogging token. This can be used
to enforce only a single use of each issued anti-clogging token request.
The token value is now token-index |
last-30-octets-of(HMAC-SHA256(sae_token_key, STA-MAC-address |
token-index)), i.e., the first two octets of the SHA256 hash value are
replaced with the token-index and token-index itself is protected as
part of the HMAC context data.

Track the used 16-bit token index values and accept received tokens only
if they use an index value that has been requested, but has not yet been
used. This makes it a bit more difficult for an attacker to perform DoS
attacks against the heavy CPU operations needed for processing SAE
commit since the attacker cannot simply replay the same frame multiple
times and instead, needs to request each token separately.

While this does not add significant extra processing/CPU need for the
attacker, this can be helpful in combination with the queued processing
of SAE commit messages in enforcing more delay during flooding of SAE
commit messages since the new anti-clogging token values are not
returned before the new message goes through the processing queue.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-06 13:07:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff9f40aee1 SAE: Process received commit message through a queue
This allows better control of processing new SAE sessions so that other
operations can be given higher priority during bursts of SAE requests,
e.g., during a potential DoS attack. The receive commit messages are
queued (up to maximum of 15 entries) and processed from eloop callback.
If the queue has multiple pending entries, more wait time is used to go
through the each new entry to reduce heavy CPU load from SAE processing.

Enable anti-clogging token use also based on the pending commit message
queue and not only based on the already started sessions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-06 13:06:50 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
941bad5ef4 SAE: Enable only group 19 by default in AP mode
Change the AP mode default for SAE to enable only the group 19 instead
of enabling all ECC groups that are supported by the used crypto library
and the SAE implementations. The main reason for this is to avoid
enabling groups that are not as strong as the mandatory-to-support group
19 (i.e., groups 25 and 26). In addition, this disables heavier groups
by default.

In addition, add a warning about MODP groups 1, 2, 5, 22, 23, and 24
based on "MUST NOT" or "SHOULD NOT" categorization in RFC 8247. All the
MODP groups were already disabled by default and would have needed
explicit configuration to be allowed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-03-05 17:21:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bb05d03606 Fix a regression from VLAN assignment using WPA/WPA2 passphrase/PSK
This extension of VLAN assignment code had a bug in one of the code
paths where vlan_id could have been left uninitialized. This could
result in SAE authentication getting rejected in cases where VLAN
assignment is not used if the uninitialized stack memory had nonzero
value.

Fixes: dbfa691df4 ("VLAN assignment based on used WPA/WPA2 passphrase/PSK")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b3957edbe9 UBSan: Split loop index decrementation into a separate step
Avoid an unnecessary unsigned integer overflow warning due to loop index
j-- use.

hostapd.c:661:10: runtime error: unsigned integer overflow: 0 - 1 cannot be represented in type 'unsigned int'

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aaa6b14984 Avoid compiler warning about potentially unaligned pointer value
(&mgmt->u.deauth.reason_code + 1) is not exactly clean and now that we
have the u8 variable[] member in the struct after this field, use that
directly to avoid clang compiler warning:
ctrl_iface_ap.c:454:18: error: taking address of packed member
      'reason_code' of class or structure 'ieee80211_mgmt::(anonymous
      union)::(anonymous)' may result in an unaligned pointer value
      [-Werror,-Waddress-of-packed-member]

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9140caf5fb UBSan: Avoid integer overflow in a loop index counter
Split the check and decrementation into separate steps to avoid an
unnecessary UBSan warning.

hostapd.c:1895:14: runtime error: unsigned integer overflow: 0 - 1 cannot be represented in type 'size_t' (aka 'unsigned long')

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8fc22fdde6 UBSan: Avoid NULL pointer dereferences on an error path
hapd->conf might be NULL in case initialized failed, so better be
prepared for that when debug printing interface name in the deinit path.

hostapd.c:312:54: runtime error: member access within null pointer of type 'struct hostapd_bss_config'
hostapd.c:351:29: runtime error: member access within null pointer of type 'struct hostapd_bss_config'
hostapd.c:2158:18: runtime error: member access within null pointer of type 'struct hostapd_bss_config'

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1b85cad29c UBSan: Use typecast to avoid unsigned integer overflow
iface->num_bss is unsigned integer, so need to explicit typecast it to
unsigned before decrementation by one even when the result is stored in
an unsigned integer.

../src/ap/hostapd.c:2185:26: runtime error: unsigned integer overflow: 0 - 1 cannot be represented in type 'unsigned long'

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-25 19:48:46 +02:00
Lior David
2c129a1b71 Fix cipher suite selector default value in RSNE for DMG
According to IEEE Std 802.11-2016, 9.4.2.25 when fields of an RSNE are
not included, the default values are used. The cipher suite defaults
were hardcoded to CCMP in the previous implementation, but the default
is actually different for DMG: GCMP (per 9.4.2.25.2).

It is not possible to find out from the RSNE if the network is non-DMG
or DMG, so callers of wpa_parse_wpa_ie_rsn() need to handle this case
based on context, which can be different for each caller.

In order to fix this issue, add flags to the wpa_ie_data indicating
whether pairwise/group ciphers were included in the RSNE. Callers can
check these flags and fill in the appropriate ciphers. The
wpa_parse_wpa_ie_rsn() function still initializes the ciphers to CCMP by
default so existing callers will not break. This change also fixes some
callers which need to handle the DMG network case.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <liord@codeaurora.org>
2019-02-21 12:42:24 +02:00
Davina Lu
66819b07b5 hostapd: Support Multi-AP backhaul STA onboarding with WPS
The Wi-Fi Alliance Multi-AP Specification v1.0 allows onboarding of a
backhaul STA through WPS. To enable this, the WPS Registrar offers a
different set of credentials (backhaul credentials instead of fronthaul
credentials) when the Multi-AP subelement is present in the WFA vendor
extension element of the WSC M1 message.

Add new configuration options to specify the backhaul credentials for
the hostapd internal registrar: multi_ap_backhaul_ssid,
multi_ap_backhaul_wpa_psk, multi_ap_backhaul_wpa_passphrase. These are
only relevant for a fronthaul SSID, i.e., where multi_ap is set to 2 or
3. When these options are set, pass the backhaul credentials instead of
the normal credentials when the Multi-AP subelement is present.

Ignore the Multi-AP subelement if the backhaul config options are not
set. Note that for an SSID which is fronthaul and backhaul at the same
time (i.e., multi_ap == 3), this results in the correct credentials
being sent anyway.

The security to be used for the backaul BSS is fixed to WPA2PSK. The
Multi-AP Specification only allows Open and WPA2PSK networks to be
configured. Although not stated explicitly, the backhaul link is
intended to be always encrypted, hence WPA2PSK.

To build the credentials, the credential-building code is essentially
copied and simplified. Indeed, the backhaul credentials are always
WPA2PSK and never use per-device PSK. All the options set for the
fronthaul BSS WPS are simply ignored.

Signed-off-by: Davina Lu <ylu@quantenna.com>
Signed-off-by: Igor Mitsyanko <igor.mitsyanko.os@quantenna.com>
Signed-off-by: Arnout Vandecappelle (Essensium/Mind) <arnout@mind.be>
Cc: Marianna Carrera <marianna.carrera.so@quantenna.com>
2019-02-18 22:35:41 +02:00
Arnout Vandecappelle (Essensium/Mind)
bfcdac1c8b Multi-AP: Don't reject backhaul STA on fronthaul BSS
The Multi-AP specification only specifies that information elements have
to be added to the Association Request and Association Response frame;
it doesn't specify anything about what should be done in case they are
missing. Previously, we rejected non-backhaul associations on a
backhaul-only BSS, and non-fronthaul associations on a fronthaul-only
BSS.

However, this makes WPS fail when fronthaul and backhaul are separate
SSIDs. Indeed, WPS for the backhaul link is performed on the *fronthaul*
SSID. Thus, the Association Request frmae used for WPS *will* contain
the Multi-AP IE indicating a backhaul STA. Rejecting that association
makes WPS fail.

Therefore, accept a multi-AP backhaul STA Association Request frame on a
fronthaul-only BSS. Still issue a warning about it, but only at level
DEBUG intead of INFO. Also change the condition checking to make it
clearer.

While we're at it, also fix the handling of unexpected bits in the
Multi-AP IE. 4 bits are reserved in the specification, so these
certainly have to be ignored. The specification also doesn't say that
setting one of the other bits is not allowed. Therefore, only report
unexpected values in the Multi-AP IE, don't reject because of it. Note
that a malformed IE (containing more than one byte) still triggers a
rejection.

Signed-off-by: Arnout Vandecappelle (Essensium/Mind) <arnout@mind.be>
2019-02-18 20:21:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2fae58fdc1 Fix wpa_psk_file parser error case handling
str_token() can return NULL for the name if the remaining token contains
only the delimiter. Fix this to avoid NULL pointer dereference with a
corner case of an invalid value used in the configuration.

Fixes: ec5c39a557 ("AP: Allow identifying which passphrase station used with wpa_psk_file")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-02-18 18:41:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b0e91e3877 SAE: VLAN assignment based on SAE Password Identifier
The new sae_password parameter [|vlanid=<VLAN ID>] can now be used to
assign stations to a specific VLAN based on which SAE Password
Identifier they use. This is similar to the WPA2-Enterprise case where
the RADIUS server can assign stations to different VLANs and the
WPA2-Personal case where vlanid parameter in wpa_psk_file is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-17 17:24:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dbfa691df4 VLAN assignment based on used WPA/WPA2 passphrase/PSK
Extend wpa_psk_file to allow an optional VLAN ID to be specified with
"vlanid=<VLAN ID>" prefix on the line. If VLAN ID is specified and the
particular wpa_psk_file entry is used for a station, that station is
bound to the specified VLAN. This can be used to operate a single
WPA2-Personal BSS with multiple VLANs based on the used passphrase/PSK.
This is similar to the WPA2-Enterprise case where the RADIUS server can
assign stations to different VLANs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-02-14 13:36:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f3a841bbff Do not disassociate not-associated STA on timeout
If the ap_handle_timer() timeout is reached for a not-associated STA, do
not default to disassociating that STA first since Disassociation frame
is not really appropriate to send to a STA that is not in associated
state. Instead, skip directly to deauthentication and STA entry removal.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-02-11 17:42:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
525923b1d7 tests: EAPOL-Key fuzzing tool
Add test-eapol program that can be used for fuzzing the EAPOL-Key
Supplicant and Authenticator implementations. This tool can write
Supplicant or Authenticator messages into a file as an initialization
step and for the fuzzing step, that file (with potential modifications)
can be used to replace the internally generated message contents.

The TEST_FUZZ=y build parameter is used to make a special build where a
hardcoded random number generator and hardcoded timestamp are used to
force deterministic behavior for the EAPOL-Key operations. This will
also make the implementation ignore Key MIC and AES keywrap errors to
allow processing of modified messages to continue further.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-02-11 02:35:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e34cd9f06e WNM: Fix WNM-Sleep Mode Request bounds checking
ieee802_11_rx_wnmsleep_req() might have been called for a short frame
that has no more payload after the Public Action field, i.e., with len
== 0. The bounds checking for the payload length was done only for the
information elements while the one octet Dialog Token field was read
unconditionally. In the original implementation, this could have
resulted in reading one octet beyond the end of the received frame data.

This case has not been reachable after the commit e0785ebbbd ("Use
more consistent Action frame RX handling in both AP mode paths"), but it
is better to address the specific issue in ieee802_11_rx_wnmsleep_req()
as well for additional protection against accidential removal of the
check and also to have something that can be merged into an older
version (pre-v2.7) if desired. The comments below apply for such older
versions where the case could have been reachable.

Depending on driver interface specific mechanism used for fetching the
frame, this could result in reading one octet beyond the end of a
stack/hash buffer or reading an uninitialized octet from within a
buffer. The actual value that was read as the Dialog Token field is not
used since the function returns immediately after having read this value
when there is no information elements following the field.

This issue was initially added in commit d32d94dbf4 ("WNM: Add
WNM-Sleep Mode implementation for AP") (with CONFIG_IEEE80211V=y build
option) and it remained in place during number of cleanup and fix
changes in this area and renaming of the build parameter to
CONFIG_WNM=y. The impacted function was not included in any default
build without one of the these optional build options being explicitly
enabled. CONFIG_WNM=y is still documented as "experimental and not
complete implementation" in hostapd/defconfig. In addition, commit
114f2830d2 ("WNM: Ignore WNM-Sleep Mode Request in wnm_sleep_mode=0
case") made this function exit before the impact read if WNM-Sleep Mode
support was not explicitly enabled in runtime configuration
(wnm_sleep_mode=1 in hostapd.conf). Commit e0785ebbbd ("Use more
consistent Action frame RX handling in both AP mode paths") made this
code unreachable in practice.

Add an explicit check that the frame has enough payload before reading
the Dialog Token field in ieee802_11_rx_wnmsleep_req().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-01-28 14:58:17 +02:00
Jared Bents
159a7fbdea crl_reload_interval: Add CRL reloading support
This patch adds a new flag 'crl_reload_interval' to reload CRL
periodically. This can be used to reload ca_cert file and the included
CRL information on every new TLS session if difference between the last
reload and the current time in seconds is greater than
crl_reload_interval.

This reloading is used for cases where check_crl is 1 or 2 and the CRL
is included in the ca_file.

Signed-off-by: Paresh Chaudhary <paresh.chaudhary@rockwellcollins.com>
Signed-off-by: Jared Bents <jared.bents@rockwellcollins.com>
2019-01-27 18:45:07 +02:00
Michal Kazior
ec5c39a557 AP: Allow identifying which passphrase station used with wpa_psk_file
It is now possible to optionally specify keyid for
each wpa_psk_file entry:

 keyid=something 00:00:00:00:00:00 secretpassphrase

When station connects and the passphrase it used
has an associated keyid it will be appended to the
AP-STA-CONNECTED event string:

 wlan0: AP-STA-CONNECTED 00:36:76:21:dc:7b keyid=something

It's also possible to retrieve it through the control interface:

 $ hostapd_cli all_sta
 Selected interface 'ap0'
 00:36:76:21:dc:7b
 ...
 keyid=something

New hostapd is able to read old wpa_psk_file. However, old hostapd will
not be able to read the new wpa_psk_file if it includes keyids.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal@plume.com>
2019-01-26 17:52:04 +02:00
Michal Kazior
b08c9ad0c7 AP: Expose PMK outside of wpa_auth module
This doesn't change any behavior on its own. It's going to be used to
expose per-station keyids and allow reloading passphrases in runtime.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal@plume.com>
2019-01-26 17:52:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
42d308635f SAE: Advertise Password Identifier use
Support the new Extended Capabilities field bits 81 and 82 to indicate
whether SAe Password Identifiers are in use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2019-01-24 00:20:49 +02:00
Siva Mullati
11ce7a1bc3 HE: Add MU EDCA Parameter Set element (AP)
Add support for configuring parameters for the MU EDCA Parameter Set
element per IEEE P802.11ax/D3.0.

Signed-off-by: Siva Mullati <siva.mullati@intel.com>
2019-01-08 17:22:43 +02:00
Zefir Kurtisi
10de40c0c8 DFS: Restart pending CAC on interface enable
When an interface is re-enabled after it was disabled during CAC, it
won't ever get active since hostapd is waiting for a CAC_FINISHED while
kernel side is waiting for a CMD_RADAR_DETECT to start a CAC.

This commit checks for a pending CAC when an interface is enabled and if
so restarts its DFS processing.

Signed-off-by: Zefir Kurtisi <zefir.kurtisi@neratec.com>
2019-01-08 01:11:56 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
bb35e2d214 hostapd: Work around an interop connection issue in FT-PSK + WPA-PSK
While the AP is configured to enable both FT-PSK and WPA-PSK, an HP
printer request both AKMs (copied from AP?) in Association Request
frame, but don't add MDIE and don't use FT. This results in the
connection failing.

Next in logs we see:

RSN: Trying to use FT, but MDIE not included
IE - hexdump(len=26): 30 18 01 00 00 0f ac 04 01 00 00 0f ac 04
                      02 00 00 0f ac 02 00 0f ac 04 00 00

This is seen with some HP and Epson printers. Work around this by
stripping FT AKM(s) when MDE is not present and there is still a non-FT
AKM available.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz@plumewifi.com>
2019-01-06 21:10:08 +02:00
Dmitry Lebed
59bf0f9713 DFS: Add supported channel bandwidth checking
While selecting a new channel as a reaction to radar event we need to
take into account supported bandwidth for each channel provided via
nl80211. Without this modification hostapd might select an unsupported
channel that would fail during AP startup.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Lebed <dlebed@quantenna.com>
2019-01-06 12:09:21 +02:00
Dmitry Lebed
75ce63e063 ACS: Add supported channel bandwidth checking
While doing automatic channel selection we need to take into account
supported bandwidth for each channel provided via nl80211. Without this
modification hostapd might select an unsupported channel which would
fail during AP startup.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Lebed <dlebed@quantenna.com>
2019-01-06 12:04:15 +02:00
Dmitry Lebed
ce6d9ce15b hostapd: Add supported channel bandwidth checking infrastructure
This adds checks to common code to verify supported bandwidth options
for each channel using nl80211-provided info. No support of additional
modes is added, just additional checks. Such checks are needed because
driver/hardware can declare more strict limitations than declared in the
IEEE 802.11 standard. Without this patch hostapd might select
unsupported channel and that will fail because Linux kernel does check
channel bandwidth limitations.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Lebed <dlebed@quantenna.com>
2019-01-06 11:54:34 +02:00
Dmitry Lebed
22dcafc20c ACS: Add support for 160 MHz bandwidth
Add support for 160 MHz BW channels to automatic channel selection
algorithm. Only 36 and 100 channels are supported as 160 MHz channels.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Lebed <lebed.dmitry@gmail.com>
2019-01-06 01:44:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4cf5efece3 FT: Allow STA entry to be removed/re-added with FT-over-the-DS
FT-over-the-DS has a special case where the STA entry (and as such, the
TK) has not yet been configured to the driver depending on which driver
interface is used. For that case, allow add-STA operation to be used
(instead of set-STA). This is needed to allow mac80211-based drivers to
accept the STA parameter configuration. Since this is after a new
FT-over-DS exchange, a new TK has been derived after the last STA entry
was added to the driver, so key reinstallation is not a concern for this
case.

Fixes: 0e3bd7ac68 ("hostapd: Avoid key reinstallation in FT handshake")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-01-04 23:22:46 +02:00
Nils Nieuwejaar
ba4f3224ae Allow remote RADIUS authentication with local VLAN management
The documentation in the hostapd.conf file says that the dynamic_vlan
variable is used to control whether VLAN assignments are accepted from a
RADIUS server. The implication seems to be that a static VLAN assignment
will come from the accept_mac_file if dynamic_vlan is set to 0, and a
dynamic assignment will come from the RADIUS server if dynamic_vlan is
set to 1. Instead, I'm seeing that the static settings from the
accept_mac_file are ignored if dynamic_vlan is set to 0, but used if
dynamic_vlan is set to 1. If dynamic_vlan is set to 1 and the RADIUS
server does not provide a VLAN, then the accept_mac_file assignment is
overridden and the STA is assigned to the default non-VLANed interface.

If my understanding of the expected behavior is correct, then I believe
the problem is in ap_sta_set_vlan(). That routine checks the
dynamic_vlan setting, but has no way of determining whether the incoming
vlan_desc is static (i.e., from accept_mac_file) or dynamic (i.e., from
a RADIUS server).

I've attached a patch that gets hostapd working as I believe it's meant
to, and updates the documentation to make the implicit behavior
explicit.

The functional changes are:

- hostapd_allowed_address() will always extract the vlan_id from the
  accept_macs file. It will not update the vlan_id from the RADIUS cache
  if dynamic_vlan is DISABLED.

- hostapd_acl_recv_radius() will not update the cached vlan_id if
  dynamic_vlan is DISABLED.

- ieee802_1x_receive_auth() will not update the vlan_id if dynamic_vlan
  is DISABLED.

More cosmetic:

Most of the delta is just moving code out of ieee802_1x_receive_auth()
into a new ieee802_1x_update_vlan() routine. While I initially did this
because the new DISABLED check introduced excessive indentation, it has
the added advantage of eliminating the vlan_description allocation and
os_memset() call for all DYNAMIC_VLAN_DISABLED configs.

I've done a couple rounds of review offline with Michael Braun (who has
done much of the work in this part of the code) and incorporated his
feedback.

If dynamic_vlan=0 (disabled), vlan assignments will be managed using the
local accept_mac_file ACL file, even if a RADIUS server is being used
for user authentication. This allows us to manage users and devices
independently.

Signed-off-by: Nils Nieuwejaar <nils.nieuwejaar@gmail.com>
2019-01-02 23:27:49 +02:00
Markus Theil
6ca4949ae1 RRM: Update own neighbor report on channel switch
After performing a successful channel switch, the AP should update its
own neighbor report element, so do this from src/ap/drv_callbacks.c
after a successful switch.

Signed-off-by: Markus Theil <markus.theil@tu-ilmenau.de>
2019-01-02 16:47:12 +02:00
Markus Theil
0998d9bd41 RRM: Move neighbor report functions
Move functions corresponding to neighbor report elements to
src/ap/neighbor_db.[c,h] in preparation to using them after channel
switch from src/ap/drv_callbacks.c.

Signed-off-by: Markus Theil <markus.theil@tu-ilmenau.de>
2019-01-02 16:47:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dc67982381 hostapd: Fix a typo in function name
This was supposed to use "hostapd_" prefix.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-01-02 16:40:34 +02:00
Sergey Matyukevich
fb60dbdcec vlan: Use new bridge ioctl()
Legacy ioctl() through SIOCDEVPRIVATE are deprecated. Follow the
approach taken by bridge-utils and make use of new bridge ioctl's
whenever possible.

For example, using legacy ioctl() breaks dynamic VLAN mode on 32-bit
Linux systems running 64-bit kernels.

Signed-off-by: Sergey Matyukevich <sergey.matyukevich.os@quantenna.com>
2019-01-02 00:23:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
28ab9344b5 Use internal EAP server identity as dot1xAuthSessionUserName
If the internal EAP server is used instead of an external RADIUS server,
sm->identity does not get set. Use the identity from the internal EAP
server in such case to get the dot1xAuthSessionUserName value in STA MIB
information.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-01-01 21:27:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2ea1fce3d6 OCE: RSSI-based rejection to consider Authentication frames (AP)
Try to make RSSI-based rejection of associating stations a bit less
likely to trigger false rejections by considering RSSI from the last
received Authentication frame. Association is rejected only if both the
Authentication and (Re)Association Request frames are below the RSSI
threshold.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2019-01-01 18:18:53 +02:00
Beni Lev
076f1ea1d9 OCE: Add RSSI based association rejection support (AP)
An AP might reject a STA association request due to low RSSI. In such
case, the AP informs the STA the desired RSSI improvement and a retry
timeout. The STA might retry to associate even if the RSSI hasn't
improved if the retry timeout expired.

Signed-off-by: Beni Lev <beni.lev@intel.com>
2019-01-01 18:18:50 +02:00
Sam Voss
dd5d325b0a hostapd: Add configuration option check_crl_strict
Add the ability to ignore time-based CRL errors from OpenSSL by
specifying a new configuration parameter, check_crl_strict=0.

This causes the following:

- This setting does nothing when CRL checking is not enabled.

- When CRL is enabled, "strict mode" will cause CRL time errors to not
  be ignored and will continue behaving as it currently does.

- When CRL is enabled, disabling strict mode will cause CRL time
  errors to be ignored and will allow connections.

By default, check_crl_strict is set to 1, or strict mode, to keep
current functionality.

Signed-off-by: Sam Voss <sam.voss@rockwellcollins.com>
2018-12-31 12:51:51 +02:00
Hristo Venev
d01203cafc hostapd: Add openssl_ecdh_curves configuration parameter
This makes it possible to use ECDSA certificates with EAP-TLS/TTLS/etc.
It should be noted that when using Suite B, different mechanism is used
to specify the allowed ECDH curves and this new parameter must not be
used in such cases.

Signed-off-by: Hristo Venev <hristo@venev.name>
2018-12-30 17:27:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b98933eafc HS 2.0: DHCP broadcast-to-unicast conversion before address learning
handle_dhcp() was first trying to learn the IP address of an associated
STA before doing broadcast-to-unicast conversion. This could result in
not converting some DHCPACK messages since the address learning part
aborts processing by returning from the function in various cases.

Reorder these operations to allow broadcast-to-unicast conversion to
happen even if an associated STA entry is not updated based on a
DHCPACK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-30 01:05:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e422a819d0 Check snprintf result to avoid compiler warnings
These do not really get truncated in practice, but it looks like some
newer compilers warn about the prints, so silence those by checking the
result and do something a bit more useful if the output would actually
get truncated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-24 11:09:22 +02:00
Felix Fietkau
4d663233e6 hostapd: Support for overriding the bridge name per VLAN via vlan_file
This makes it easier to integrate dynamic VLANs in custom network
configurations. The bridge name is added after the interface name in the
vlan_file line, also separated by whitespace.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@nbd.name>
2018-12-21 12:02:57 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
d2c4d1ee11 AP: Configure FTM responder parameters
Enable FTM responder and configure LCI and civic if ftm_responder
configuration option is set. Since ftm_responder configuration existed
before and was used to set extended capability bits, don't fail AP setup
flow if ftm_responder is set, but the driver doesn't advertise FTM
responder support.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2018-12-21 11:19:25 +02:00
Venkateswara Naralasetty
9c06f0f6ae hostapd: Add Multi-AP protocol support
The purpose of Multi-AP specification is to enable inter-operability
across Wi-Fi access points (APs) from different vendors.

This patch introduces one new configuration parameter 'multi_ap' to
enable Multi-AP functionality and to configure the BSS as a backhaul
and/or fronthaul BSS.

Advertise vendor specific Multi-AP capabilities in (Re)Association
Response frame, if Multi-AP functionality is enabled through the
configuration parameter.

A backhaul AP must support receiving both 3addr and 4addr frames from a
backhaul STA, so create a VLAN for it just like is done for WDS, i.e.,
by calling hostapd_set_wds_sta(). Since Multi-AP requires WPA2 (never
WEP), we can safely call hostapd_set_wds_encryption() as well and we can
reuse the entire WDS condition.

To parse the Multi-AP Extension subelement, we use get_ie(): even though
that function is meant for parsing IEs, it works for subelements.

Signed-off-by: Venkateswara Naralasetty <vnaralas@codeaurora.org>
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
Signed-off-by: Arnout Vandecappelle (Essensium/Mind) <arnout@mind.be>
2018-12-20 01:04:14 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
fa97981265 OCV: Include and verify OCI in WNM-Sleep Exit frames
Include and verify the OCI element in WNM-Sleep Exit Request and
Response frames. In case verification fails, the frame is silently
ignored.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:50:12 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
716ed96e8d OCV: Pass ocv parameter to mesh configuration
Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:50:12 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
99621dc16c OCV: Include and verify OCI in the FILS handshake
Include and verify the OCI element in FILS (Re)Association Request and
Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:50:12 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
f91e68e903 OCV: Perform an SA Query after a channel switch
After the network changed to a new channel, perform an SA Query with the
AP after a random delay if OCV was negotiated for the association. This
is used to confirm that we are still operating on the real operating
channel of the network. This commit is adding only the station side
functionality for this, i.e., the AP behavior is not changed to
disconnect stations with OCV that do not go through SA Query.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:50:12 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
f9da7505bf OCV: Include and verify OCI in SA Query frames
Include an OCI element in SA Query Request and Response frames if OCV
has been negotiated.

On Linux, a kernel patch is needed to let clients correctly handle SA
Query Requests that contain an OCI element. Without this patch, the
kernel will reply to the SA Query Request itself, without verifying the
included OCI. Additionally, the SA Query Response sent by the kernel
will not include an OCI element. The correct operation of the AP does
not require a kernel patch.

Without the corresponding kernel patch, SA Query Requests sent by the
client are still valid, meaning they do include an OCI element.
Note that an AP does not require any kernel patches. In other words, SA
Query frames sent and received by the AP are properly handled, even
without a kernel patch.

As a result, the kernel patch is only required to make the client properly
process and respond to a SA Query Request from the AP. Without this
patch, the client will send a SA Query Response without an OCI element,
causing the AP to silently ignore the response and eventually disconnect
the client from the network if OCV has been negotiated to be used.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:42:23 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
dd8df6af0b OCV: Include and verify OCI in the FT handshake
Include and verify the the OCI element in (Re)Association Request and
Response frames of the FT handshake. In case verification fails, the
handshake message is silently ignored.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:42:23 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
aed61c4efa OCV: Verify OCI in 4-way and group key handshake
Verify the received OCI element in the 4-way and group key handshakes.
If verification fails, the handshake message is silently dropped.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:42:23 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
1034f67bf1 OCV: Add function to derive Tx parameters to a specific STA
Use the information elements that were present in the (Re)Association
Request frame to derive the maximum bandwidth the AP will use to
transmit frames to a specific STA. By using this approach, we don't need
to query the kernel for this information, and avoid having to add a
driver API for that.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 15:42:19 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
f53aeff415 OCV: Parse all types of OCI information elements
Add functionality to parse all variations of the OCI element.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 00:02:14 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
17c2559caf OCV: Insert OCI in 4-way and group key handshake
If Operating Channel Verification is negotiated, include the OCI KDE
element in EAPOL-Key msg 2/4 and 3/4 of the 4-way handshake and both
messages of the group key handshake.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-17 00:02:14 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
1e93e4239f OCV: Track STA OCV capability in AP mode
Check and store OCV capability indication for each STA.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 20:49:13 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
875ab60d73 OCV: Advertise OCV capability in RSN capabilities (AP)
Set the OCV bit in RSN capabilities (RSNE) based on AP mode
configuration. Do the same for OSEN since it follows the RSNE field
definitions.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 20:48:48 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
9c55fdb023 OCV: Add hostapd config parameter
Add hostapd.conf parameter ocv to disable or enable Operating Channel
Verification (OCV) support.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 20:31:21 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
ad20a1367f Store the VHT Operation element of an associated STA
APs and mesh peers use the VHT Operation element to advertise certain
channel properties (e.g., the bandwidth of the channel). Save this
information element so we can later access this information.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 18:35:30 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
bef4d07a28 Make channel_info available to authenticator
This adds the necessary functions and callbacks to make the channel_info
driver API available to the authenticator state machine that implements
the 4-way and group key handshake. This is needed for OCV.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 18:35:30 +02:00
Mathy Vanhoef
7f00dc6e15 Add driver API to get current channel parameters
This adds driver API functions to get the current operating channel
parameters. This encompasses the center frequency, channel bandwidth,
frequency segment 1 index (for 80+80 channels), and so on.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-12-16 18:35:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7bd8c76a4f HS 2.0 server: RADIUS server support for SIM provisioning
This adds support for hostapd-as-RADIUS-authentication-server to request
subscription remediation for SIM-based credentials. The new hostapd.conf
parameter hs20_sim_provisioning_url is used to set the URL prefix for
the remediation server for SIM provisioning. The random
hotspot2dot0-mobile-identifier-hash value will be added to the end of
this URL prefix and the same value is stored in a new SQLite database
table sim_provisioning for the subscription server implementation to
use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-12-15 18:01:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f3784a6b94 HS 2.0: Reject Hotspot 2.0 Rel 2 or newer association without PMF
Hotspot 2.0 Rel 2 requires PMF to be enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-12-08 14:06:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6ae04d7b34 HS 2.0: Allow Hotspot 2.0 release number to be configured
The new hostapd configuration parameter hs20_release can be used to
configure the AP to advertise a specific Hotspot 2.0 release number
instead of the latest supported release. This is mainly for testing
purposes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-12-08 14:06:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
17adac9ef9 FILS: Do not process FILS HLP request again while previous one is pending
It is better not to process a new (most likely repeated) FILS HLP
request if a station retransmits (Re)Association Request frame before
the previous HLP response has either been received or timed out. The
previous implementation ended up doing this and also ended up
rescheduling the fils_hlp_timeout timer in a manner that prevented the
initial timeout from being reached if the STA continued retransmitting
the frame. This could result in failed association due to a timeout on
the station side.

Make this more robust by processing (and relaying to the server) the HLP
request once and then ignoring any new HLP request while the response
for the relayed request is still pending. The new (Re)Association
Request frames are otherwise processed, but they do not result in actual
state change on the AP side before the HLP process from the first
pending request is completed.

This fixes hwsim test case fils_sk_hlp_oom failures with unmodified
mac80211 implementation (i.e., with a relatively short retransmission
timeout for (Re)Association Request frame).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-12-07 16:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
678d8410af Move send_probe_response parameter to BSS specific items
This can be more convenient for testing Multiple BSSID functionality.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-12-07 15:03:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9da196adf9 VLAN: Warn about interface name truncation
Add more snprintf checks to make it clearer if some of the ifname
constructions would end up being too long.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-03 12:44:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8fc6d88465 OWE: Fix association rejection behavior
If association failed for any non-OWE specific reason, the previous
implementation tried to add the OWE related IEs into the (Re)Association
Response frame. This is not needed and could actually result in
dereferencing a NULL pointer. Fix this by adding those OWE related IEs
only for successful association and only if the RSN state machine has
been initialized.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-02 20:21:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e22c23382f DPP: Apply testing configuration option to signing of own config
Previous implementation had missed this case of setting configurator
parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-02 00:26:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e0785ebbbd Use more consistent Action frame RX handling in both AP mode paths
Both handle_action() and hostapd_action_rx() are used for processing
received Action frames depending on what type of driver architecture is
used (MLME in hostapd vs. driver) and which build options were used to
build hostapd. These functions had a bit different sequence for checking
the frame and printing debug prints. Make those more consistent by
checking that the frame includes the category-specific action field and
some payload. Add a debug print for both functions to make it easier to
see which path various Action frames use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-12-01 20:30:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff50101139 FT: Check session_timeout pointer consistently
Avoid smatch warning on this even thought the only caller of the
function uses a non-NULL pointer in all cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-30 21:28:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0227028444 EAP DB: Use NULL to clear a pointer
Avoid a sparse warning from use of a plain integer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-30 21:28:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3d1d469195 Fix indentation level
This gets rid of smatch warnings about inconsistent indenting.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-30 21:28:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a00d65e79f DPP: Reject invalid no-psk/pass legacy configurator parameters
Instead of going through the configuration exchange, reject invalid
legacy configurator parameters explicitly. Previously, configuring
legacy (psk/sae) parameters without psk/pass resulted in a config object
that used a zero length passphrase. With this change, that config object
is not sent and instead, either the initialization attempts is rejected
or the incoming initialization attempt is ignored.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-30 17:14:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
04924b28b5 OWE: Fix a compiler warning in non-testing build
The new conf variable was used only within the CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS
block and as such, added a warning about unused variable into
non-testing builds. Fix that by using that variable outside the
conditional block as well.

Fixes: a22e235fd0 ("OWE: Add testing RSNE for OWE assoc response with driver SME/MLME")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-27 20:49:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6e7b4c45fa Fix hostapd config file reloading with BSS addition/removal
BSS additional/removal cases were not considered at all in the previous
implementation of hostapd configuration file reloading on SIGHUP. Such
changes resulted in num_bss values getting out of sync in runtime data
and configuration data and likely dereferencing of freed memory (e.g.,
when removing a BSS).

Fix this by forcing a full disable/enable sequence for the interface if
any BSS entry is added/removed or if an interface name changes between
the old and the new configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-11-26 00:51:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
adbce7443d HS 2.0: Update HS2.0 AP version RADIUS attribute Version field
Use HS20_VERSION macro to determine if R3 should be indicated instead of
R2.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-11-09 23:38:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ab3ab50757 HS 2.0: Fix Terms and Conditions URL handling
Do not try to determine the length of the T&C Server URL before checking
that the URL is available. This got broken in a change to move the
handling to the AS. hostapd could potentially have hit a NULL pointer
dereference if the authentication server sent an unconsistent set of T&C
information.

Fixes: d4e39c51f8 ("HS 2.0: Move Terms and Conditions Server URL generation from AP to AS")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-30 19:15:11 +02:00
Ankita Bajaj
0f0aa2a640 OCE: Move OCE checks to IE formation from hostapd initialization
Earlier, the OCE flags were checked during hostapd initialization. This
doesn't address few cases like for example when the interface is added
from control interface. Move the OCE flag checks to the functions that
are forming the MBO/OCE IEs to cover all the different paths for
enabling a BSS. Also use macros as appropriate for readability.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-30 15:43:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d514b50265 WNM: Collocated Interference Reporting
Add support for negotiating WNM Collocated Interference Reporting. This
allows hostapd to request associated STAs to report their collocated
interference information and wpa_supplicant to process such request and
reporting. The actual values (Collocated Interference Report Elements)
are out of scope of hostapd and wpa_supplicant, i.e., external
components are expected to generated and process these.

For hostapd/AP, this mechanism is enabled by setting
coloc_intf_reporting=1 in configuration. STAs are requested to perform
reporting with "COLOC_INTF_REQ <addr> <Automatic Report Enabled> <Report
Timeout>" control interface command. The received reports are indicated
as control interface events "COLOC-INTF-REPORT <addr> <dialog token>
<hexdump of report elements>".

For wpa_supplicant/STA, this mechanism is enabled by setting
coloc_intf_reporting=1 in configuration and setting Collocated
Interference Report Elements as a hexdump with "SET coloc_intf_elems
<hexdump>" control interface command. The hexdump can contain one or
more Collocated Interference Report Elements (each including the
information element header). For additional testing purposes, received
requests are reported with "COLOC-INTF-REQ <dialog token> <automatic
report enabled> <report timeout>" control interface events and
unsolicited reports can be sent with "COLOC_INTF_REPORT <hexdump>".

This commit adds support for reporting changes in the collocated
interference (Automatic Report Enabled == 1 and partial 3), but not for
periodic reports (2 and other part of 3).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-30 14:07:51 +02:00
Ilan Peer
f13aaf33fb AP: Place the WPA IE in the correct order
In case the protocol used for the BSS is WPA, the WPA vendor IE should
be placed after all the non vendor IEs. Fix this for Beacon and Probe
Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2018-10-20 11:28:29 +03:00
Sriram R
7b2ca5cf0d hostapd: Reset channel switch parameters on interface disable
Previously, when an AP interface was disabled through a control
interface DISABLE command during a channel switch window, the interface
could not be reenabled due to beacon setup failure (which validates if
CSA is in progress).

Fix this by clearing channel switch parameters while disabling the
hostapd interface.

Signed-off-by: Sriram R <srirrama@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-19 21:26:03 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
68500d8159 AP: Warn about VLAN interface name truncations
Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2018-10-16 12:56:04 +03:00
Sathishkumar Muruganandam
72a09d43fe Fix 5 GHz to 2.4 GHz channel switch with hostapd through DISABLE/ENABLE
When moving a 5 GHz VHT AP to 2.4 GHz band with VHT disabled through the
hostapd control interface DISABLE/reconfig/ENABLE commands, enabling of
the AP on 2.4 GHz failed due to the previously configured VHT capability
being compared with hardware VHT capability on 2.4 GHz band:

hw vht capab: 0x0, conf vht capab: 0x33800132
Configured VHT capability [VHT_CAP_MAX_MPDU_LENGTH_MASK] exceeds max value supported by the driver (2 > 0)
ap: interface state DISABLED->DISABLED

Since VHT (ieee80211ac) config is already disabled for the 2.4 GHz band,
add fix this by validating vht_capab only when VHT is enabled.

Fixes: c781eb8428 ("hostapd: Verify VHT capabilities are supported by driver")
Signed-off-by: Sathishkumar Muruganandam <murugana@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-16 00:50:40 +03:00
Ashok Kumar
edb28006c4 PMF: Do not start SA Query procedure if there is no association
Previous implementation ended up triggering PMF check for previous
association and SA Query procedure incorrectly in cases where there is a
STA entry in hostapd, but that STA is not in associated state. This
resulted in undesired temporary rejection of the association with status
code 30.

This ended up breaking OWE group negotiation when PMF is in use since
the check for the OWE group would have happened only after this earlier
PMF check and rejection (i.e., the station got status code 30 instead of
the expected 77).

For example, when the AP is configured with OWE group 21 and a station
tries groups 19, 20, and 21 (in this sequence), the first two
Association Request frames should be rejected with status code 77.
However, only the first one got that status code while the second one
got status code 30 due to that issue with PMF existing association
check.

Furthermore, hostapd was continuing with SA Query procedure with
unencrypted Action frames in this type of case even though there was no
existing association (and obviously, not an encryption key either).

Fix this by checking that the STA entry is in associated state before
initiating SA Query procedure based on the PMF rules.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Kumar <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-16 00:33:20 +03:00
Hauke Mehrtens
74eebe93d0 SAE: Do not ignore option sae_require_mfp
Without this patch sae_require_mfp is always activate, when ieee80211w
is set to optional all stations negotiating SAEs are being rejected when
they do not support PMF. With this patch hostapd only rejects these
stations in case sae_require_mfp is set to some value and not null.

Fixes ba3d435fe4 ("SAE: Add option to require MFP for SAE associations")
Signed-off-by: Hauke Mehrtens <hauke@hauke-m.de>
2018-10-14 20:13:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dc1b1c8db7 Drop logging priority for handle_auth_cb no-STA-match messages
This message was printed and MSG_INFO level which would be more
reasonable for error cases where hostapd has accepted authentication.
However, this is not really an error case for the cases where
authentication was rejected (e.g., due to MAC ACL). Drop this to use
MSG_DEBUG level.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-10-14 20:03:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6588f71222 Reduce undesired logging of ACL rejection events from AP mode
When Probe Request frame handling was extended to use MAC ACL through
ieee802_11_allowed_address(), the MSG_INFO level log print ("Station
<addr> not allowed to authenticate") from that function ended up getting
printed even for Probe Request frames. That was not by design and it can
result in excessive logging and MSG_INFO level if MAC ACL is used.

Fix this by printing this log entry only for authentication and
association frames. In addition, drop the priority of that log entry to
MSG_DEBUG since this is not really an unexpected behavior in most MAC
ACL use cases.

Fixes: 92eb00aec2 ("Extend ACL check for Probe Request frames")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-10-14 19:57:22 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
18003b315b AS: Add an event_cb() callback handler
This provides debug log information on TLS events on the server side.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-11 12:12:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cad810a98f HS 2.0: OSU Provider NAI List advertisement
Extend hostapd to allow the new OSU Provider NAI List ANQP-element to be
advertised in addition to the previously used OSU Providers list
ANQP-element. The new osu_nai2 configurator parameter option is used to
specify the OSU_NAI value for the shared BSS (Single SSID) case while
osu_nai remains to be used for the separate OSU BSS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-10-05 20:49:42 +03:00
Andreas Tobler
b5ebe5dd5b hostapd: Send an event before throwing a station on re-authentication
If you modify the WLAN-STA-AUTHORIZED bit in sta->flags, you have to
call the ap_sta_set_authorized() function to make sure the corresponding
event is sent over the control interface. Otherwise we leak entries in
the event history.

Signed-off-by: Andreas Tobler <andreas.tobler@cloudguard.ch>
2018-09-02 12:48:32 +03:00
Chaitanya T K
410e2dd1d6 OWE: Fix build error in AP code without CONFIG_IEEE80211W=y
When CONFIG_OWE is enabled but none of 11R/11W/FILS are enabled hostapd
(and wpa_supplicant with AP mode support) build failed. Fix this by
adding OWE to the list of conditions for including the local variables.

Signed-off-by: Chaitanya T K <chaitanya.mgit@gmail.com>
2018-09-02 12:38:16 +03:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
20f612d998 DPP: Set group id through DPP_AUTH_INIT or dpp_configurator_params
This enhances DPP_AUTH_INIT, DPP_CONFIGURATOR_SIGN, and SET
dpp_configurator_params to allow optional setting of the DPP groupId
string for a Connector. If the value is not set, the previously wildcard
value ("*") is used by default.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-08-30 23:34:00 +03:00
Hu Wang
567df5501c Re-configure WEP keys on hostapd interface re-enable
This allows WEP mode AP to be re-enabled automatically after external
ifconfig down + up on netdev used by hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-08-21 18:50:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c6e1a9a0b3 Clarify the TODO comment regarding PMKID KDE in EAPOL-Key msg 1/4
Make it clear that the consideration should be only for the IBSS case
and in infrastructure BSS case, PMKID KDE should not be added due to
risks involved with exposing this to stations that do not know the
passphrase.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-08-10 13:51:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d4e39c51f8 HS 2.0: Move Terms and Conditions Server URL generation from AP to AS
This makes it more convenient to generate the URL in a way that
interoperates between different vendors. The AP is simply copying the
already constructed URL as-is from Access-Accept to WNM-Notification.
This means that the HO AAA can generate the URL in a manner that works
for the associated T&C Server without having to coordinate with each AP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-06-21 20:50:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3a8dd390c9 SAE: Allow authentication restart on AP
In the infrastructure BSS case, the AP needs to clear pending SAE state
if a new Commit message is received when already in Committed state.
This allows the non-AP STA to negotiate a new group if it ends up trying
to go through SAE authentication again before the AP side has removed
the previous STA entry.

This fixes an issue where a kernel update changed something in SAE
timing or authentication sequence and started failing the
sae_bignum_failure hwsim test case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-06-20 13:04:31 +03:00
Martin Willi
4a0e011560 AP: Fix HT 20/40 co-ex transition timer cancellation on iface removal
When removing an interface, hostapd_bss_deinit() frees all associated
STAs. If any of the stations is 40MHz intolerant, the cleanup invokes
ht40_intolerant_remove(), that in turn registers a 20->40MHz transition
timer for the last station (ap_ht2040_timeout() function). That timer is
never canceled; once it executes, the interface is gone, most likely
resulting in a segfault when referencing it.

While hostapd_interface_deinit() cancels the transition timer, it does
so before cleaning up STAs. Move the cancellation after STA cleanup to
cancel any timer that was registered during that operation.

Signed-off-by: Martin Willi <martin@strongswan.org>
2018-06-12 21:45:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c3e4f40cd6 FT: Derive PMKR0Name/PMKR1Name using SHA-384 with AKM 00-0F-AC:13
The AKM 00-0F-AC:13 is supposed to use cryptographic algorithms
consistently, but the current IEEE 802.11 standard is not doing so for
the key names: PMKID (uses SHA-1), PMKR0Name/PMKR1Name (uses SHA-256).
The PMKID case was already implemented with SHA-384 and this commit
replaces use of SHA-256 with SHA-384 for PMKR0Name/PMKR1Name derivation
to be consistent in SHA-384. While this is not compliant with the
current IEEE 802.11 standard, this is clearly needed to meet CNSA Suite
requirements. Matching change is being proposed in REVmd to get the IEEE
802.11 standard to meet the use case requirements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-06-06 23:59:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e8d08cf378 SAE: Do not drop STA entry on reauthentication in infrastructure BSS
A new SAE Commit message should not be allowed to drop an existing STA
entry since the sender of that Commit message cannot be authenticated
before receiving the Confirm message. This is important in particular
when PMF is used since this would provide a potential new path for
forcing a connection to be dropped.

Fix this by allowing a new SAE Authentication instance to be started
when the old instance is in Accepted state and the new Commit message
does not use the same peer-scalar value (checked in
sae_parse_commit_scalar()). When PMF is used, the AP will use SA Query
procedure when receiving the (Re)Association Request frame. In theory,
that step could be skipped in case of SAE Authentication since the
non-AP STA is demonstrating knowledge of the password. Anyway, there is
no allowance for that exception in the IEEE 802.11 standard, so at least
for now, leave this using SA Query procedure just like any other PMF
case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-06-06 01:22:01 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ff168f8c23 FT: Support 256-bit IGTK in AP case
hostapd was hardcoded to use 128-bit IGTK in FT protocol (IGTK
subelement in FTE). Extend that to allow 256-bit IGTK (i.e.,
BIP-CMAC-256 and BIP-GMAC-256) to be used as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 21:50:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2cf36d6085 FT: Handle AssocResp generation failures as fatal errors
Instead of sending out a partially completed frame, abort the
association process if something unexpected happens and remove the STA
entry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 21:50:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
657b4c45a9 FILS: Fix KEK2 use in FT-FILS use cases
When support for KCK2 and KEK2 was added, both keys were derived for
FT-FILS cases, but only KCK2 was actually used. Add similar changes to
use KEK2 to protect GTK/IGTK in FTE with using FT-FILS AKMs.

This fixes AES key wrapping to use the correct key. The change is not
backwards compatible.

Fixes: 2f37387812 ("FILS: Add more complete support for FT-FILS use cases")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 21:04:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
661afb2edd FT: Fix RRB error path handling
When building an RRB message, a failure in wpa_ft_rrb_lin() calls could
have resulted in trying to free an uninitialized pointer. Fix this by
initializing *packet to NULL before going through the initial steps.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 20:16:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3d9cd08410 FT: Add support for variable length PMK-R1 receiving in RRB
SHA384-based FT AKM uses longer keys, so the RRB receive processing for
push and pull response messages needs to be able to accept variable
length PMK-R1.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 20:16:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a7968ea568 FT: FTE generation for SHA384-based AKM on AP
The MIC field is now a variable length field, so make FTE generation in
hostapd aware of the two different field lengths.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 20:16:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9a33737a0b FT: FTE parsing for SHA384-based AKM
The MIC field is now a variable length field, so make the FTE parser
aware of the two different field lengths.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 19:29:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
994eac7e61 FT: PMK-R0 derivation using SHA384-based AKM
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 19:29:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9f12271b2a FT: XXKey derivation for SHA384-based AKM
XXKey is the first 384 bits of MSK when using the SHA384-based FT AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 19:29:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a3e18dbb6a FT: Support variable length keys
This is a step in adding support for SHA384-based FT AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 19:29:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c22bb5bba6 FT: SHA384-based AKM in RSNE processing
This defines key lengths for SHA384-based FT AKM and handles writing and
parsing for RSNE AKMs with the new value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-06-05 01:11:41 +03:00
Markus Theil
b375b04b67 WNM: Fix time_zone advertisement without time_zone configuration
If time_advertisement=2 is included in hostapd configuration, but
time_zone is unset, the previous implementation tried to write the Time
Zone element into management frames. This resulted in segmentation fault
when trying to dereference a NULL pointer. Fix that by skipping addition
of this element when time_zone parameter is not set.

Signed-off-by: Markus Theil <markus.theil@tu-ilmenau.de>
2018-05-31 12:53:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8d660a4bac HS 2.0: Allow OSEN connection to be enabled in an RSN BSS
This allows a single BSS/SSID to be used for both data connection and
OSU. Instead of hostapd configuration osen=1, wpa_key_mgmt=OSEN (or more
likely, wpa_key_mgmt=WPA-EAP OSEN) is used to enable this new option.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-05-29 23:34:22 +03:00
Dan Harkins
d52ead3db7 EAP-pwd server: Add support for salted password databases
These changes add support for salted password databases to EAP-pwd per
RFC 8146. This commits introduces the framework for enabling this and
the salting mechanisms based on SHA-1, SHA256, and SHA512 hash
algorithms.

Signed-off-by: Dan Harkins <dharkins@lounge.org>
2018-05-28 22:08:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9be19d0b9c SAE: Add support for using the optional Password Identifier
This extends the SAE implementation in both infrastructure and mesh BSS
cases to allow an optional Password Identifier to be used. This uses the
mechanism added in P802.11REVmd/D1.0. The Password Identifier is
configured in a wpa_supplicant network profile as a new string parameter
sae_password_id. In hostapd configuration, the existing sae_password
parameter has been extended to allow the password identifier (and also a
peer MAC address) to be set. In addition, multiple sae_password entries
can now be provided to hostapd to allow multiple per-peer and
per-identifier passwords to be set.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-05-19 17:30:29 +03:00
Sathishkumar Muruganandam
bda9c08596 hostapd: Fix CHAN_SWITCH command for VHT20 and VHT40
Previously, hostapd CHAN_SWITCH command did not effect VHT configuration
for the following:

When VHT is currently disabled (ieee80211ac=0),

1. hostapd_cli -p /var/run/hostapd chan_switch 10 5180 \
                sec_channel_offset=1 center_freq1=5190 bandwidth=40 ht

====> Comes up in HT40

2. hostapd_cli -p /var/run/hostapd chan_switch 10 5765 \
                sec_channel_offset=-1 center_freq1=5775 bandwidth=40 vht

====> Comes up in HT40

3. hostapd_cli -p /var/run/hostapd chan_switch 10 5200 center_freq1=5200 \
                                                  bandwidth=20 vht

====> Comes up in HT20

When VHT is currently enabled (ieee80211ac=1),

1. hostapd_cli -p /var/run/hostapd chan_switch 10 5180 \
                sec_channel_offset=1 center_freq1=5190 bandwidth=40 ht

====> Comes up in VHT40

2. hostapd_cli -p /var/run/hostapd chan_switch 10 5200 center_freq1=5200 \
                                                  bandwidth=20 ht

====> Comes up in VHT20

This is since VHT config from chan_switch is processed only for
bandwidths 80 and above (80P80, 160) and for VHT20, VHT40 cases, only
NLA chan type and chan width are updated.

There is no NL attribute for determining if it is HT or VHT for
bandwidths 20 & 40 and currently they are updated as HT20, HT40 (+ or -
depending on offset). Same is notified back via
NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY.

Instead of adding new NL attribute for tracking HT/VHT enabled config,
we are adding new hostapd VHT config parameter to save the chan_switch
config and use only for chan_switch case of VHT20 and VHT40.

Tested with all combinations of chan_switch (noHT->20->40->80->) HT/VHT
and confirmed to be working.

Signed-off-by: Sathishkumar Muruganandam <murugana@codeaurora.org>
2018-05-16 01:16:54 +03:00
Karthikeyan Periyasamy
c4dd3afa3c ACS: Avoid invalid interference factor when survey channel time is zero
When the channel time is zero the interference factor calculation falls
under divide by zero operation which results in invalid (NaN =
not-a-number) interference factor value. This leads to wrong ideal
channel selection in ACS during the scenario described below.

Scenario:

In VHT80 mode, the channel 36 (first channel) gets the channel time as
zero which causes the interfactor factor to be an invalid number (NaN).
Any operations (like addition, mulitplication, divide, etc.) with NaN
value results in a NaN value, so that average factor for the primary
channel 36 got the invalid value (NaN). Since channel 36 is the first
channel, ideal factor is assigned as NaN in the first iteration. The
following iteration condition check (factor < ideal_factor) with a NaN
value fail for all other primary channels. This results in channel 36
being chosen as the ideal channel in ACS which holds a NaN value.

Logs:

ACS: Survey analysis for channel 36 (5180 MHz)
ACS: 1: min_nf=-103 interference_factor=nan nf=0 time=0 busy=0 rx=0
ACS: 2: min_nf=-103 interference_factor=0.615385 nf=-102 time=13 busy=8 rx=0
ACS: 3: min_nf=-103 interference_factor=2.45455 nf=0 time=22 busy=16 rx=0
ACS: 4: min_nf=-103 interference_factor=0.785714 nf=-103 time=42 busy=33 rx=0
ACS: 5: min_nf=-103 interference_factor=nan nf=0 time=0 busy=0 rx=0
ACS:  * interference factor average: nan
...
ACS:  * channel 36: total interference = nan
..
ACS:  * channel 149: total interference = 5.93174e-21
..
ACS: Ideal channel is 36 (5180 MHz) with total interference factor of nan

Signed-off-by: Karthikeyan Periyasamy <periyasa@codeaurora.org>
2018-05-16 01:16:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d501c27cfe EAP-TLS server: Disable TLS v1.3 by default
The current EAP peer implementation is not yet ready for the TLS v1.3
changes with EAP-TTLS, EAP-PEAP, and EAP-FAST, so disable TLS v1.3 for
this EAP method for now.

While the current EAP-TLS implementation is more or less complete for
TLS v1.3, there has been no interoperability testing with other
implementations, so disable for by default for now until there has been
chance to confirm that no significant interoperability issues show up
with TLS version update. tls_flags=[ENABLE-TLSv1.3] configuration
parameter can be used to enable TLS v1.3 (assuming the TLS library
supports it; e.g., when using OpenSSL 1.1.1).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-05-01 22:13:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4526038092 HS 2.0: Terms and Conditions testing feature in authentication server
Allow hostapd RADIUS authentication server with SQLite EAP user DB to be
used for testing Terms and Conditions functionality. This could be used
for the HO AAA part of functionality (merging HO AAA and SP AAA into a
single component to avoid separate RADIUS proxy in testing setup).

A T&C server with HTTPS processing is needed to allow this to be used
for full over-the-air testing. This commit adds sufficient functionality
to allow hwsim test cases to cover the RADIUS server part.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-26 17:56:22 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f456940ef3 HS 2.0: CoA-Request processing for Terms and Conditions filtering
Extend RADIUS DAS to support CoA-Request packets for the case where the
HS 2.0 Terms And Conditions filtering VSA is used to remove filtering.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-25 12:57:46 +03:00
mazumdar
d239ab3962 DFS: Mark channels required DFS based on reg-domain info from the driver
Mark a channel as required DFS based on regulatory information received
from the driver/kernel rather than deciding based on hardcoded
boundaries on the frequency. Previously few channels were being marked
as requiring DFS even though they were non-DFS in a particular country.

If the driver does not provide channel list information, fall back to
the previously used frequency-based determination.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-24 00:35:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8760b9848c HS 2.0: Send Terms and Conditions Acceptance notification
This extends hostapd Access-Accept processing to check if the RADIUS
server indicated that Terms and Conditions Acceptance is required. The
new hs20_t_c_server_url parameter is used to specify the server URL
template that the STA is requested to visit.

This commit does not enable any kind of filtering, i.e., only the part
of forwarding a request from Access-Accept to the STA using
WNM-Notification is covered.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-24 00:35:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6cb8f4f382 HS 2.0: Terms and Conditions attributes in Access-Request messages
This extends hostapd with two new configuration parameters
(hs20_t_c_filename and hs20_t_c_timestamp) that can be used to specify
that the Terms and Conditions attributes are to be added into all
Access-Request messages for Hotspot 2.0 STAs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-24 00:35:47 +03:00
Bhagavathi Perumal S
1952b626ba hostapd: Add ctrl iface indications for WDS STA interface
This allows user to get event indication when a new interface is
added/removed for 4addr WDS STA and also WDS STA ifname is informed
through the STA command.

Signed-off-by: Bhagavathi Perumal S <bperumal@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-24 00:35:47 +03:00
Tova Mussai
c4315e6620 AP: Handle AP initalization failure in async flow
When AP initialization is completed in a callback (e.g., OBSS scan),
wpa_supplicant_deinit_ap() is not called in case of failure. Fix this by
calling setup_complete_cb in case of failure, too, which in turn calls
wpa_supplicant_deinit_ap() if needed.

Signed-off-by: Tova Mussai <tova.mussai@intel.com>
2018-04-20 00:48:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
67cca34645 HS 2.0: Copy Roaming Consortium OI from (Re)AssocReq to Access-Request
This extends hostapd processing of (Re)Association Request frames to
store a local copy of the Consortium OI within the Roaming Consortium
Selection element, if present, and then add that in HS 2.0 Roaming
Consortium attribute into RADIUS Access-Request messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-17 16:40:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0e450db285 HS 2.0: Allow configuration of operator icons
This extends hostapd Hotspot 2.0 implementation to allow operator icons
to be made available. The existing hs20_icon parameter is used to define
the icons and the new operator_icon parameter (zero or more entries) is
used to specify which of the available icons are operator icons. The
operator icons are advertised in the Operator Icon Metadata ANQP-element
while the icon data can be fetched using the same mechanism (icon
request/binary file) that was added for the OSU Providers icons.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-17 16:40:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4d6eb9f2e2 Fix hostapd wmm_enabled setup on config reload path
If there is no explicit wmm_enabled parameter in the configuration
(i.e., conf->wmm_enabled == -1), the configuration reload path needs to
initialize conf->wmm_enabled based on iconf->ieee80211n in
hostapd_reload_bss() similarly to what is done in the initial startup
case in hostapd_setup_bss().

This fixes issues with RSN capabilities being set incorrectly when WMM
is supposed to get enabled and unexpectedly enabling WMM when it is not
supposed to be enabled (HT disabled). Either of these issues could show
up when asking hostapd to reload the configuration file (and when that
file does not set wmm_enabled explicitly).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-04-06 23:29:11 +03:00
Michael Braun
a6509e850e FT: Add session_timeout to push/resp
This ensures a session timeout configured on R0KH either using
RADIUS-based ACL or 802.1X authentication is copied over to the new
R1KH.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:57:53 +03:00
Michael Braun
3cb286ca49 FT: Add set/get session_timeout callback functions
These are needed to allow wpa_auth_ft.c to control session_timeout
values for STAs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:48:15 +03:00
Michael Braun
13f118dc59 Convert STA session_timeout to os_reltime
This is needed to allow the remaining session time to be computed for FT
(when sending PMK-R1 to another AP).

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:48:11 +03:00
Michael Braun
069b4e3048 FT: Include identity and radius_cui in pull/resp frames
This allows APs using FT to get the EAP session information from R0KH to
R1KHs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:09:16 +03:00
Michael Braun
9fbe292ff3 FT: Move wpa_ft_rrb_build_r0() special case to caller
Handle the special case of no PMK-R0 entry in the caller instead of
having to have wpa_ft_rrb_build_r0() aware of the possibility of pmk_r0
being NULL.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:09:16 +03:00
Michael Braun
8c345234fd FT: Add set/get identity/radius_cui callback functions
These are needed to allow wpa_auth_ft.c to control identity/radius_cui
values for STAs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:01:16 +03:00
Michael Braun
17a8a9893f Fix potential memory leak with identity/radius_cui
ieee802_11_set_radius_info() might be called with a STA entry that has
already stored identity and/or radius_cui information, so make sure the
old values get freed before being replaced by the new ones.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:01:16 +03:00
Michael Braun
17010c38d0 FT: Add IEEE VLAN support (including tagged VLANs)
This uses set_vlan()/get_vlan() callbacks to fetch and configure the
VLAN of STA. Transmission of VLAN information between APs uses new TLVs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-06 19:01:13 +03:00
Michael Braun
47a039b01b FT: Add set_vlan()/get_vlan() callback functions
These are needed to allow wpa_auth_ft.c to control VLAN assignment for
STAs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-05 22:39:21 +03:00
Michael Braun
3a3e28320b FT: Add expiration to PMK-R0 and PMK-R1 cache
IEEE Std 802.11-2016, 12.7.1.7.1 indicates that the lifetime of the
PMK-R0 (and PMK-R1) is bound to the lifetime of PSK or MSK from which
the key was derived. This is currently stored in r0_key_lifetime, but
cache entries are not actually removed.

This commit uses the r0_key_lifetime configuration parameter when
wpa_auth_derive_ptk_ft() is called. This may need to be extended to use
the MSK lifetime, if provided by an external authentication server, with
some future changes. For PSK, there is no such lifetime, but it also
matters less as FT-PSK can be achieved without inter-AP communication.

The expiration timeout is then passed from R0KH to R1KH. The R1KH verifies
that the given timeout for sanity, it may not exceed the locally configured
r1_max_key_lifetime.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-05 13:58:20 +03:00
Michael Braun
09211c9894 FT: Use dl_list for PMK-R0/R1 cache
This makes it easier to remove expired entries from the list.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-05 13:56:04 +03:00
Michael Braun
89dea17e13 FT: Add helper function for FILS key storing
FILS calls wpa_ft_store_pmk_r0() from wpa_auth.c. This is moved into a
new function wpa_ft_store_pmk_fils() in preparation of additional
information being needed.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-05 13:47:43 +03:00
Michael Braun
83fe4bd3bf FT: Convert r0_key_lifetime to seconds
Add a new configuration option ft_r0_key_lifetime that deprecates
r0_key_lifetime. Though, the old configuration is still accepted for
backwards compatibility.

This simplifies testing. All other items are in seconds as well. In
addition, this makes dot11FTR0KeyLifetime comment match with what got
standardized in the end in IEEE Std 802.11r-2008.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2018-04-05 13:47:23 +03:00
Ben Greear
c6b5b9a33b hostapd: Add more authentication error case debugging
This can help one understand better why stations are failing
to authenticate.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2018-04-02 16:53:10 +03:00
Ben Greear
e2fc13d0ab hostapd: Add logging around Michael MIC related failures
This can help one understand better why stations are failing
to authentication/associate.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2018-04-02 16:51:29 +03:00
Ben Greear
e7525a2954 hostapd: Add send_auth_reply() caller info in debug logging
This can help one understand better what happens during the
authentication exchange.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2018-04-02 16:47:26 +03:00
Mathy Vanhoef
9f917339cc tests: Fix clearing of IGTK PN in handshake retransmit test functions
When locating the position of the IGTK PN in the key data, we also need
to skip the KDE header, in addition to the keyid field. This fixes
hostapd RESEND_M3 and RESEND_GROUP_M1 behavior when PMF is negotiated
for the association. Previously, the IGTK KDE ended up getting
practically hidden since zeroing of the PN ended up clearing the KDE OUI
and Type fields.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2018-04-01 21:47:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7e1d3ee963 Add hostapd.conf venue_url to set Venue URL ANQP-element
The new venue_url parameter can now be used to set the Venue URL ANQP
information instead of having to construct the data and use
anqp_elem=277:<hexdump> to set the raw value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-26 16:10:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2f37387812 FILS: Add more complete support for FT-FILS use cases
This extends the original IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016 functionality with the
changes added in REVmd to describe how additional keys are derived to
protect the FT protocol using keys derived through FILS authentication.

This allows key_mgmt=FT-FILS-SHA256 to be used with FT protocol since
the FTE MIC can now be calculated following the changes in REVmd. The
FT-FILS-SHA384 case is still unsupported (it needs support for variable
length MIC field in FTE).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-26 12:31:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4ddca8142e FT: Derive PMK-R1 locally if requested PMKR0Name is found
Derive PMK-R1 locally if the derived PMKR1Name is not found from the
local cache, but the request is for a key that was originally generated
locally (R0KH-ID matches) and the PMKR0Name is found in the local cache.
This was apparently not hit in the previously used FT sequences, but
this is useful to have available if a PMK-R1 entry is dropped from the
local cache before PMK-R0.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-24 18:53:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1dc0945cc9 FT: Do not send PMK-R1 pull request to own R0KH address
If the requested key is not available locally, there is no point in
trying to send a pull request back to self for the key.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-24 18:53:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9d94e4bb6b SAE: Fix PMKID in EAPOL-Key msg 1/4
Previously, the association that used SAE authentication ended up
recalculating the PMKID for EAPOL-Key msg 1/4 using incorrect
PMK-to-PMKID derivation instead of using the previously derived PMKID
from SAE. The correct PMKID was used only when going through PMKSA
caching exchange with a previously derived PMKSA from SAE.

Fix this by storing the SAE PMKID into the state machine entry for the
initial SAE authentication case when there is no explicit PMKSA entry
attached to the station.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-23 18:44:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
10949e2480 Do not disable 40 MHz based on co-ex report with matching primary channel
When processing 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management frames that do not
explicitly require 40 MHz to be disabled, check whether the reported
channels in 20/40 BSS Intolerant Channel Report element match the
current primary channel. If so, allow 40 MHz operation to continue. This
makes the during-operation updates for 20/40 Operation Permitted more
consistent with the scans during initial BSS startup.

The received 20/40 BSS Intolerant Channel Report channels are to be used
in the OT set in the during-operation determination and the P == OT_i
exception was ignored in the previous implementation which could result
in the AP first starting with 40 MHz and then dropping to 20 MHz on
first received 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management frame even though there
was no change in the neighboring BSSs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-21 16:58:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8cbd9c3ed4 Support multiple 20/40 BSS Intolerant Channel Report elements
This extends 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management frame processing to
iterate over all the included 20/40 BSS Intolerant Channel Report
elements instead of using only the first one.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-21 16:53:50 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8127a0ac02 Ignore intra-BSS 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management from not-associated STA
The 20 MHz BSS Width Request field is set to 1 only for intra-BSS
reports. As such, ignore the frame if such a claim is made by a
transmitter that is not currently associated with the AP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-21 16:35:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8aa599d45a Add more debug prints for 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management frame Rx
This makes it easier to understand what kind of information a STA is
reporting about 20/40 MHz coexistence requirements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-21 16:32:35 +02:00
Rajkumar Manoharan
d58c3bd8b7 hostapd: Ignore LOW_ACK event for co-operative steering clients
Ignore hostapd_event_sta_low_ack for a station which has agreed to
steering by checking the agreed_to_steer flag. This flag will be set
whenever a station accepts the BSS transition request from the AP.
Without this ignoring of the LOW_ACK event, the steering in-progress
might be affected due to disassociation. In this way AP will allow some
time (two seconds) for the station to move away and reset the flag after
the timeout.

Co-Developed-by: Tamizh Chelvam <tamizhr@codeaurora.org>
Signed-off-by: Rajkumar Manoharan <rmanohar@codeaurora.org>
Signed-off-by: Tamizh chelvam <tamizhr@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-19 20:16:32 +02:00
Tamizh chelvam
ec2b5173ce Make STA opmode change event available to upper layers
Add an event callback for EVENT_STATION_OPMODE_CHANGED to allow
user/application to get the notification whenever there is a change in a
station's HT/VHT op mode.

The new events:
STA-OPMODE-MAX-BW-CHANGED <addr> <20(no-HT)|20|40|80|80+80|160>
STA-OPMODE-SMPS-MODE-CHANGED <addr> <automatic|off|dynamic|static>
STA-OPMODE-N_SS-CHANGED <addr> <N_SS>

Signed-off-by: Tamizh chelvam <tamizhr@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-19 20:07:22 +02:00
Bhagavathi Perumal S
72123a84cb hostapd: Add last_ack_rssi into ctrl iface cmd STA
This allows external application to get last ACK signal strength of the
last transmitted frame if the driver makes this information
(NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL) available.

Signed-off-by: Bhagavathi Perumal S <bperumal@codeaurora.org>
Signed-off-by: Venkateswara Naralasetty <vnaralas@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-19 19:23:26 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
f5701cc66e OWE: Clean up pointer check in a testing code path
Check wpa_auth_write_assoc_resp_owe() return value to keep static
analyzers happier. The code path where this could happen is not really
reachable due to the separate hapd->conf->own_ie_override check and
wpa_auth_write_assoc_resp_owe() returning NULL only in an error case in
the override path. Furthermore, clean up the pointer return value to use
a proper pointer (NULL vs. 0).

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-19 19:08:34 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
8179ae3a2a DPP: Support retrieving of configurator's private key
To retain configurator information across hostapd/wpa_supplicant
restart, private key need to be maintained to generate a valid pair of
authentication keys (connector, netaccess_key, csign) for new enrollees
in the network.

Add a DPP_CONFIGURATOR_GET_KEY control interface API through which the
private key of an existing configurator can be fetched.

Command format:
DPP_CONFIGURATOR_GET_KEY <configurator_id>

The output from this command can then be used with
"DPP_CONFIGURATOR_ADD key=<hexdump>" to create the same key again.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-16 20:55:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4bc801ab42 SAE: Fix EAPOL-Key integrity and key-wrap algorithm selection
The SAE AKM 00-0F-AC:8 is supposed to use EAPOL-Key Key Descriptor
Version 0 (AKM-defined) with AES-128-CMAC and NIST AES Key Wrap.
However, the previous implementation ended up using Key Descriptor
Version 2 (HMAC-SHA-1-128 and NIST AES Key Wrap). Fix this by using the
appropriate Key Descriptor Version and integrity algorithm. Use helper
functions to keep the selection clearer and more consistent between
wpa_supplicant and hostapd uses.

Note: This change is not backwards compatible. Both the AP and station
side implementations will need to be updated at the same time to
maintain functionality.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-16 13:36:42 +02:00
Srinivas Dasari
d74963d411 DPP: Extend dpp_test 89 functionality to transmit side
This extends dpp_test functionality to allow DPP exchanges to be stopped
after authentication is completed on the Initiator, i.e., after sending
out the Authentication Confirm message. Previously, dpp_test=89 was used
only on the Responder side to stop after receiving the Authentication
Confirm message. The main use case for this extended functionality is to
be able to stop the protocol exchange on a device that acts as
authentication Initiator and Enrollee.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-13 01:03:37 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
f8bfc9cbde Use correct WPA_ALG_* values to compare for enum wpa_alg
enum wpa_alg was being compared with WPA_CIPHER_* values. That does not
work here and strict compilers will report this as an error. Fix the
comparision to use proper WPA_ALG_* values. This fixes testing
capability for resetting IPN for BIP.

Fixes: 16579769ff ("Add testing functionality for resetting PN/IPN for configured keys")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-13 00:32:43 +02:00
Tamizh chelvam
92eb00aec2 Extend ACL check for Probe Request frames
Extend ACL check to deny Probe Request frames for the client which does
not pass ACL check. Skip this check for the case where RADIUS ACL is
used to avoid excessive load on the RADIUS authentication server due to
Probe Request frames. This patch add wpa_msg event for auth and assoc
rejection due to acl reject.

Signed-off-by: Tamizh chelvam <tamizhr@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-03 00:42:16 +02:00
Jeffin Mammen
c05f96a386 FILS: Check kde more consistently to avoid static analyzer warnings
For FILS, __wpa_send_eapol() is called only with the kde != NULL, but a
static analyzer might not understand that. Add an explicit check kde !=
NULL similarly to the other cases going through the kde parameter to
silence such bogus warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jeffin Mammen <jmammen@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-02 21:27:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f5e0a3324b SAE: Fix potential infinite loop in mismatching PMK case on AP
Commit e61fea6b46 ('SAE: Fix PMKSA caching
behavior in AP mode') modified the PSK fetching loop to not override PMK
in case of SAE with PMKSA caching. However, that commit missed the error
path cases where there is need to break from the loop with exact
negative of the check in the beginning of the loop. This could result in
hitting an infinite loop in hostapd if a station derived a different PMK
value from otherwise successfully completed SAE authentication or if a
STA used a different PMK with a PMKSA caching attempt after a previously
completed successful authentication.

Fix this by adding the matching break condition on SAE AKM within the
loops.

Fixes: e61fea6b46 ("SAE: Fix PMKSA caching behavior in AP mode")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-03-02 21:27:18 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
a22e235fd0 OWE: Add testing RSNE for OWE assoc response with driver SME/MLME
Allow RSNE to be overwritten for testing purposes also in the
driver-based SME/MLME case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-12 21:31:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
659ac96d7f ieee802_11_mgmt: Handle frame info more consistently
Check for the fi parameter to be non-NULL before trying to fetch the
ssi_signal information similarly to how the fi->freq was already
handled. While the meta information is supposed to be available, it
looks like there is at least one corner case where fi == NULL could be
used (Authentication frame reprocessing after RADIUS-based ACL).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-02-07 12:34:41 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
458d8984de SAE: Reject request with mismatching PMKID (no PMKSA cache entry)
Reject SAE association request when PMKID is included in the RSNE, but
the corresponding PMKSA is not available in the AP.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-07 12:24:36 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
79ce2d519b OWE: Rename function to match use (driver-SME/MLME)
This function is used to process a (Re)Association Request frame, so
rename it appropriately to mention assoc_req instead of auth_req.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-06 20:27:41 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
759da93a89 OWE: Check for ECDH availability before use (driver-SME/MLME)
Verify that the STA has ECDH data available before trying to use this
data to add the OWE DH Params element.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-06 20:25:41 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
af65ef28f4 OWE: Add RSNE when not using PMKSA caching (driver-SME/MLME)
RSNE needs to be added both with and without use of PMKSA caching.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-06 20:22:53 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
5850cba384 OWE: Support DH groups 20 and 21 with driver-SME/MLME
This was already the case with the hostapd-based SME/MLME
implementation, but the OWE DH Param element construction for the
driver-based SME/MLME needed a matching change to set the group
properly.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-06 20:20:22 +02:00
Michal Kazior
f9854c183d hostapd: Fix wpa_psk_file support for FT-PSK
For FT-PSK sm->xxkey was populated with only the first password on the
linked list (i.e., last matching password in the wpa_psk_file) in
INITPSK. This caused only that password to be recognized and accepted.
All other passwords were not verified properly and subsequently
prevented clients from connecting.

Hostapd would report:

 Jan 30 12:55:44 hostapd: ap0: STA xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx WPA: sending 1/4 msg of 4-Way Handshake
 Jan 30 12:55:44 hostapd: ap0: STA xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx WPA: received EAPOL-Key frame (2/4 Pairwise)
 Jan 30 12:55:44 hostapd: ap0: STA xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx WPA: invalid MIC in msg 2/4 of 4-Way Handshake
 Jan 30 12:55:45 hostapd: ap0: STA xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx WPA: EAPOL-Key timeout

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal@plumewifi.com>
2018-02-04 12:39:23 +02:00
David Messer
82424732af Fix compiler issue with CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS
Use the preprocessor conditional "ifdef" instead of "if" before
CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS to prevent an issue on build systems that treat
undefined preprocessor identifiers as an error.

Signed-off-by: David Messer <david.messer@garmin.com>
2018-02-03 12:41:09 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
cd483be252 OWE: Use PMKSA caching if available with driver AP MLME
If a matching PMKSA cache entry is present for an OWE client, use it and
do not go through DH while processing Association Rquest frame.
Association Response frame will identify the PMKID in such a case and DH
parameters won't be present.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-01 23:58:46 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
a4668c6812 OWE: Handle unsupported finite cyclic group with driver MLME
Handle OWE unsupported finite cyclic group in (Re)Association Request
frame when not using the hostapd SME/MLME.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-02-01 23:51:19 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
18e3e9c6e0 OWE: Transition mode with non-AP-MLME
Add OWE Transition IE in build_ap_extra() ies to support drivers that do
not use hostapd MLME.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-29 19:01:43 +02:00
Ashok Ponnaiah
92b6e0c582 hostapd: Send broadcast Public Action frame with wildcard BSSID address
Send Public Action frames with wildcard BSSID when destination was
broadcast address. This is required for DPP PKEX where the recipients
may drop the frames received with different BSSID than the wildcard
address or the current BSSID.

Signed-off-by: Ashok Ponnaiah <aponnaia@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-29 18:11:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
703470bfa1 FILS: Fix extended capability bit setting for FILS in AP mode
FILS capability bit setting could have ended up setting boths biths 72
(correct) and 64 (incorrect; part of Max Number of MSDUs In A-MSDU). Fix
this by adding the missing break to the switch statement.

Fixed: f55acd909e ("FILS: Set FILS Capability bit in management frames from AP")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-01-22 00:07:44 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b6b5e3554a DPP: Get rid of compiler warnings on signed/unsigned comparison
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2018-01-21 11:24:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5d5ee699a5 Copy WLAN-Reason-Code value from Access-Reject to Deauthentication
This makes hostapd use the WLAN-Reason-Code value from Access-Reject
when disconnecting a station due to IEEE 802.1X authentication failure.
If the RADIUS server does not include this attribute, the default value
23 (IEEE 802.1X authentication failed) is used. That value was the
previously hardcoded reason code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-12 20:55:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
feba5848be Replace RSNE group key management mismatch status/reason codes
Use "cipher out of policy" value instead of invalid group cipher (which
is for the group data frame cipher) and management frame policy
violation (which is used for MFPC/MFPR mismatch).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-12 01:12:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fd92095491 DPP: Report reception of Config Request to upper layers
This is mainly for protocol testing purposes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-12 00:50:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
80f71b71d5 DPP: Authentication exchange retries and channel iteration in hostapd
This extends hostapd with previoiusly implemented wpa_supplicant
functionality to retry DPP Authentication Request/Response and to
iterate over possible negotiation channels.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-08 05:19:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c5cc7a59ac Report offchannel RX frame frequency to hostapd
Not all code paths for management frame RX reporting delivered the
correct frequency for offchannel RX cases. This is needed mainly for
Public Action frame processing in some special cases where AP is
operating, but an exchange is done on a non-operational channel. For
example, DPP Initiator role may need to do this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@codeaurora.org>
2018-01-08 03:37:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
02b38d0ad5 Fix MFP-enabled test for disallowed TKIP
The test against use of TKIP was done only in MFP-required
(ieee80211w=2) configuration. Fix this to check the pairwise cipher for
MFP-enabled (ieee80211w=1) case as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-27 18:38:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ba3d435fe4 SAE: Add option to require MFP for SAE associations
The new hostapd.conf parameter sae_require_pmf=<0/1> can now be used to
enforce negotiation of MFP for all associations that negotiate use of
SAE. This is used in cases where SAE-capable devices are known to be
MFP-capable and the BSS is configured with optional MFP (ieee80211w=1)
for legacy support. The non-SAE stations can connect without MFP while
SAE stations are required to negotiate MFP if sae_require_mfp=1.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-27 18:27:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c4fc7e31c7 SAE: Set special Sc value when moving to Accepted state
Set Sc to 2^16-1 when moving to Accepted state per IEEE Std 802.11-2016,
12.4.8.6.5 (Protocol instance behavior - Confirmed state). This allows
the peer in Accepted state to silently ignore unnecessary
retransmissions of the Confirm message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-27 12:19:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
abcbd0604c SAE: Add Rc variable and peer send-confirm validation
This implements the behavior described in IEEE Std 802.11-2016,
12.4.8.6.6 (Protocol instance behavior - Accepted state) to silently
discard received Confirm message in the Accepted state if the new
message does not use an incremented send-confirm value or if the special
2^16-1 value is used. This avoids unnecessary processing of
retransmitted Confirm messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-27 12:19:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9249afc8e1 SAE: Print state changes in debug log
This makes it easier to follow state changes in SAE protocol instances.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-27 00:07:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d8b841eba8 SAE: Make dot11RSNASAESync configurable
The new hostapd.conf parameter sae_sync (default: 5) can now be used to
configure the dot11RSNASAESync value to specify the maximum number of
synchronization errors that are allowed to happen prior to
disassociation of the offending SAE peer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-26 12:46:22 +02:00
Bhagavathi Perumal S
af832aa998 hostapd: Add average channel utilization in STATUS
This allows external programs to get the average channel utilization.
The average channel utilization is calculated and reported through
STATUS command. Users need to configure chan_util_avg_period and
bss_load_update_period in hostapd config to get the average channel
utilization.

Signed-off-by: Bhagavathi Perumal S <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-12 00:48:27 +02:00
Bhagavathi Perumal S
802c0fd0c3 hostapd: Update BSS load update period dynamically
Recalculate the timeout value for each event instead of calculating this
once and then not allowing the timeout configuration to be changed
without fully stopping and restarting the interface.

This allows the bss_load_update_period configuration parameter to be
modified while a BSS continues operating.

Signed-off-by: Bhagavathi Perumal S <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-12 00:48:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
778d87054e Fix error handling in bss_load_update_period parser
Do not update the configuration parameter before having verified the
value to be in the valid range.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-12 00:46:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
04ded82efa OWE: Fix error case handling with drivers that implement AP SME
owe_auth_req_process() can return NULL in error cases, but the caller
was not prepared for this. The p pointer cannot be overridden in such
cases since that would result in buffer length (p - buf) overflows. Fix
this by using a temporary variable to check the return value before
overriding p so that the hostapd_sta_assoc() ends up using correct
length for the IE buffer.

Fixes: 33c8bbd8ca ("OWE: Add AP mode handling of OWE with drivers that implement SME")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-11 13:41:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e5c7c2f28e Fix ap-mgmt-fuzzer build
Add src/ap/eth_p_oui.o into libap.a to be able to link ap-mgmt-fuzzer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-12-09 18:41:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
402c8e00b7 WPS: Map GCMP-256 and CCMP-256 to AES encryption type
This is needed to allow a credential to be built for GCMP-256/CCMP-256
networks that do not enable GCMP-128/CCMP-128.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-02 12:00:45 +02:00
Shiva Sankar Gajula
a2660890a5 WPS: Allow WPS to be enabled in CCMP-256 and GCMP-256 only cases
Extend the check against WPA/TKIP only configuration by adding CCMP-256
and GCMP-256 to the list of allowed ciphers. This is needed to allow WPS
to be enabled in AP configurations where neither CCMP-128 nor GCMP-128
are enabled.

Signed-off-by: Shiva Sankar Gajula <sgajula@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-12-02 12:00:44 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ed62d40116 DPP: Deinit PKEX instance on DPP_STOP_LISTEN
Previously this stopped only the DPP Authentication instance, but it is
better to clear both PKEX and Authentication.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-29 12:24:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
634a130a52 DPP: Clear authentication instance on configuration completion in AP
wpa_supplicant was already doing this and hostapd needs to clear
hapd->dpp_auth when completing the exchange in Configurator (GAS server)
role.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-27 20:33:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d3cb7ebe1b DPP: Do not process dpp_auth_ok_on_ack multiple times
An additional TX status callback could result in processing the DPP
authentication completion another time at least with hostapd. Fix this
by clearing the dpp_auth_ok_on_ack when processing it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-27 20:20:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a2588be82c DPP: Add DPP_CONFIGURATOR_SIGN support to hostapd
Configurator signing its own Connector was previously supported only in
wpa_supplicant. This commit extends that to hostapd to allow an AP
acting as a Configurator to self-configure itself.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-27 13:24:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7eb6bfb45d DPP: Move hostapd Configurator/bootstrap data into global context
This moves the Configurator and Bootstrapping Information data from
struct hostapd_data (per-BSS) to struct hapd_interfaces (per-hostapd
process). This allows the information to be maintained over interface
restarts and shared between interfaces.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-27 13:24:20 +02:00
Bhagavathi Perumal S
0bd7f104c1 hostapd: Add supported rate information into STATUS and STA
These allow external programs to determine supported legacy, HT, and VHT
rates of an interface or a STA.

Signed-off-by: Bhagavathi Perumal S <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-25 13:25:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1489fcf87d FILS: Do not leave error value in left counter
If fils_decrypt_assoc() were to fail on the AP side, the previous
implementation could have continued through the response generation
using left = -1. That could have resulted in unexpected processing if
this value were to be used as the length of the remaining (unencrypted)
IEs. Fix this by not updating left in the failure case.

Fixes: 78815f3dde ("FILS: Decrypt Association Request elements and check Key-Auth (AP)")
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-24 12:26:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
beae255a72 WPA: Check wpa_eapol_key_mic() result on TX
Verify that nothing unexpected happened with EAPOL-Key Key MIC
calculation when transmitting EAPOL-Key frames from the Authenticator.
This should not be able to happen in practice, but if if it does, there
is no point in sending out the frame without the correct Key MIC value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-24 12:13:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
af4103e5e9 DPP: Provide peer_mac to PKEX Initiator through function argument
Avoid unnecessary direct write to a struct dpp_pkex member from outside
dpp.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-23 23:32:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3ca4be1eaa DPP: Remove compiler warnings about signed/unsigned comparisons
These timestamp comparisons did not use matching signedness.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-23 20:31:12 +02:00
Hu Wang
63dc0f9c4d hostapd: Disassoc STA without WPA/RSN IE if AP proto is WPA/RSN
With the AP proto configured being WPA/RSN and SME in the
driver, the previous implementation in hostapd is to not
process hostapd_notif_assoc() due to "No WPA/RSN IE from STA",
if the (Re)Association Request frame is without the WPA/RSN IEs.

Enhance that to disassociate such station provided the AP is not using
WPS.

Signed-off-by: Hu Wang <huw@codeaurora.org>
2017-11-23 20:12:34 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
cc79e06f00 hostapd: Add wpa_msg_ctrl() to report Probe Request frames from STA
This allows external applications to get event indication for Probe
Request frames. Extend ctrl iface cmd "ATTACH" to enable this event on
per-request basis. For example, user has to send ctrl iface cmd "ATTACH
probe_rx_events=1" to enable the Probe Request frame events.

Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-23 20:12:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e3a5882b3e DPP: Add SAE credential support to Configurator
The new conf={sta,ap}-{sae,psk-sae} parameter values can now be used to
specify that the legacy configuration object is for SAE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-22 21:24:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5dd745b738 DPP: Add akm=sae and akm=psk+sae support in Enrollee role
This allows DPP to be used for enrolling credentials for SAE networks in
addition to the legacy PSK (WPA-PSK) case. In addition, enable FT-PSK
and FT-SAE cases automatically.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-22 21:23:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4b8de0c929 DPP: Protocol testing for invalid Peer Discovery Req/Resp values
Extend dpp_test to allow more invalid attribute values to be written
into Peer Discovery Request/Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-19 17:15:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c6eb3e34b6 Stronger GTK derivation routine
If the build include SHA384, use that to derive GTK from GMK. In
addition, add more random bytes bytes to the PRF-X() context data for
longer GTK to reduce dependency on the randomness of the GMK.

GMK is 256 bits of random data and it was used with SHA256, so the
previous design was likely sufficient for all needs even with 128 bits
of additional randomness in GTK derivation. Anyway, adding up to 256
bits of new randomness and using SHA384 can be helpful extra protection
particularly for the cases using GCMP-256 or CCMP-256 as the group
cipher.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-11-18 17:50:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
27781c0ab5 Allow group cipher selection to be overridden
The new hostapd configuration parameter group_cipher can now be used to
override the automatic cipher selection based on enabled pairwise
ciphers. It should be noted that selecting an unexpected group cipher
can result in interoperability issues and this new capability is mainly
for testing purposes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-17 12:31:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c1d3773967 DPP: Stop authentication exchange of DPP_STOP_LISTEN
Previously, this command stopped listen operation immediately, but if
there was an ongoing authentication exchange, a new listen operation was
started. This is not really expected behavior, so stop the
authentication exchange first with this command to avoid restarting
listen operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-13 12:35:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d1f082644c DPP: Allowed initiator to indicate either role
The new role=either parameter can now be used with DPP_AUTH_INIT to
indicate that the initiator can take either the Configurator or Enrollee
role.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-13 11:45:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f97ace34cb DPP: Support multiple channels for initiating DPP Authentication
This extends wpa_supplicant to iterate over all available channels from
the intersection of what the peer indicates and the local device
supports when initiating DPP Authentication. In addition, retry DPP
Authentication Request frame up to five times if no response is
received.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-13 11:45:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a306ed5a58 DPP: Protocol testing to allow missing attributes in peer discovery
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-06 12:40:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1fafdf1124 DPP: Add DPP_LISTEN and DPP_STOP_LISTEN to hostapd
This is an initial step in allowing non-operating channel operations
with DPP when hostapd is the Responder. For now, this is only used for
specifying role=configurator/enrollee and qr=mutual cases similarly to
the wpa_supplicant configuration for in Responder role. Request to use a
non-operating channel will be rejected.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-04 12:33:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
29ab69e4b0 DPP: PKEX counter t
Add limit on number of failed attempts that could have used PKEX code.
If the limit (5) is reached, drop the PKEX state (including the code)
and report this on the control interface to indicate that a new code
needs to be entered due to possible attack.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-03 19:59:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
039b8e7369 DPP: Terminate PKEX exchange on detection of a mismatching code
Clean up the pending PKEX exchange if Commit-Reveal Request processing
indicates a mismatch in the PKEX code. Previously, the this case was
silently ignored and the session was left in pending state that
prevented new PKEX exchanges from getting initated. Now, a new attempt
is allowed to be initiated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-03 19:59:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e0247e7983 DPP: PKEX and STATUS_BAD_GROUP
Report mismatching finite cyclic group with PKEX Exchange Response using
STATUS_BAD_GROUP and provide more detailed error report over the control
interface on the peer device when this happens.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-03 19:59:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fe12ae777f Fix Status Code in TKIP countermeasures case
The previously used WLAN_REASON_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE (14) value as a
response to Authentication frame or (Re)Association Request frame is not
correct since the resp value is encoded in the Status Code (not Reason
Code) field. Status Code 14 is WLAN_STATUS_UNKNOWN_AUTH_TRANSACTION
which is really what this value would have meant in the response frames.

There is no Michael MIC failure status code, so have to use the generic
"Unspecified failure" (1) reason code for these cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-03 19:59:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
06f2df0693 DPP: Fix hostapd control interface events for initiator case
Incorrect msg_ctx was registered for the wpa_msg() calls from the DPP
module.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-02 12:25:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
219d4c9fcb DPP: Report possible PKEX code mismatch in control interface
Indicate to upper layers if PKEX Commit-Reveal Request frame AES-SIV
decryption fails. That is a likely sign of the PKEX code mismatch
between the devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-02 12:25:35 +02:00
Lior David
0c3bc1be09 Fix test build breakage when not compiling with ieee80211w support
Build breakage was introduced by commit
d8afdb210e ('Allow EAPOL-Key messages 1/4
and 3/4 to be retransmitted for testing') for some
CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds without CONFIG_IEEE80211W=y.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-11-01 12:50:20 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
ea4ace9c76 hostapd: Add max_txpower into STATUS command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 11:49:41 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
bf6c65afce hostapd: Add Beacon interval and DTIM period into STATUS command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 11:45:29 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
c7ae2b3104 hostapd: Add HT/VHT capability info into STATUS command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 11:41:38 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
1f91a8bdea hostapd: Add HT/VHT capability info into STA command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 11:37:20 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
65f9db6bc2 hostapd: Add extended capabilities into STA command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 00:31:31 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
d1f3a81446 hostapd: Add [HT] flag into STA command
Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 00:28:46 +02:00
bhagavathi perumal s
ba72b4b126 hostapd: Add Min/Max Transmit Power Capability into STA command
This provides access to the Minimum/Maximum Transmit Power Capabilitie
fileds (the nominal minimum/maximum transmit power with which the STA
is capable of transmitting in the current channel; signed integer in
units of decibels relative to 1 mW).

Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-31 00:22:58 +02:00
Ashok Kumar Ponnaiah
33c8bbd8ca OWE: Add AP mode handling of OWE with drivers that implement SME
Handle OWE DH exchange and key setup when processing the association
event from a driver that implements AP SME.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-30 23:24:42 +02:00
Ashok Kumar Ponnaiah
28d1264131 Check hostapd current_mode before dereferencing it in additional places
While most places using this should be for cases where the hw_features
functionality is required, there seem to be some paths that are getting
exposed in new OWE related operations where that might not be the case.
Add explicit NULL pointer checks to avoid dereferencing the pointer if
it is not set when operating with driver wrappers that do not provide
sufficient information.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-30 23:20:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
348c93847a AP-side workaround for WNM-Sleep Mode GTK/IGTK reinstallation issues
Normally, WNM-Sleep Mode exit with management frame protection
negotiated would result in the current GTK/IGTK getting added into the
WNM-Sleep Mode Response frame. Some station implementations may have a
vulnerability that results in GTK/IGTK reinstallation based on this
frame being replayed. Add a new hostapd configuration parameter that can
be used to disable that behavior and use EAPOL-Key frames for GTK/IGTK
update instead. This would likely be only used with
wpa_disable_eapol_key_retries=1 that enables a workaround for similar
issues with EAPOL-Key. This is related to station side vulnerabilities
CVE-2017-13087 and CVE-2017-13088. To enable this AP-side workaround,
set wnm_sleep_mode_no_keys=1.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-29 17:13:54 +02:00
Johannes Berg
3f5a1860a8 wpa_auth: Deplete group rekey eloop handler for strict rekeying
When strict group rekeying is in effect, every station that leaves will
cause a rekeying to happen 0.5 s after leaving. However, if a lot of
stations join/leave, the previous code could postpone this rekeying
forever, since it always re-registers the handling with a 0.5 s timeout.

Use eloop_deplete_timeout() to address that, only registering the
timeout from scratch if it wasn't pending.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2017-10-29 17:04:14 +02:00
Johannes Berg
92662fb281 Allow forcing group rekeying for testing purposes
In order to test the WoWLAN GTK rekeying KRACK mitigation, add a
REKEY_GTK hostapd control interface command that can be used at certain
points of the test.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2017-10-29 16:58:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d270920692 DPP: Negotiation channel change request from Initiator
Allow the Initiator to request a different channel to be used for DPP
Authentication and DPP Configuration exchanges. This commit adds support
for this in wpa_supplicant with the optional neg_freq=<freq in MHz>
parameter in DPP_AUTH_INIT.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-29 16:08:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e85b660129 DPP: Add DPP Status attribute into Peer Discovery Response
This was added in DPP tech spec v0.2.7 to allow result of network
introduction to be reported.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-29 12:16:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
26806abe85 DPP: Report invalid messages and failure conditions in control interface
This is useful for protocol testing purposes and UI needs to display
more detailed information about DPP exchanges.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-22 22:45:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
af48810ba3 DPP: Report transmitted messages as control interface events
This is helpful for testing purposes and also for upper layer components
that may want to show more detailed progress through a DPP exchange.
Both the DPP-TX and DPP-TX-STATUS events are provided.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-22 17:21:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a707393494 DPP: Report received messages as control interface events
This is helpful for testing purposes and also for upper layer components
that may want to show more detailed progress through a DPP exchange.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-22 17:21:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
27fefbbb76 DPP: Remove unnecessary Wrapped Data checks from callers
Now that dpp_check_attrs() takes care of verifying that no attributes
are after the Wrapped Data attribute, the duplicated checks in hostapd
and wpa_supplicant side of the implementation can be removed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-22 17:21:57 +03:00
Ben Greear
74e55b6585 Fix test build breakage when not compiling with mesh support
Build breakage was introduced by commit
16579769ff ('Add testing functionality for
resetting PN/IPN for configured keys') for some CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y
builds.

Signed-off-by: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2017-10-21 10:59:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3d0fb95583 WNM: Ignore BSS Transition Management frames in bss_transition=0 case
The hostapd bss_transition parameter was previously used to control
advertisement of BSS Transition Management support, but it was not used
when processing BSS Transition Management Query/Response frames. Add an
explicit check during frame processing as well so that any misbehaving
station is ignored. In addition to bss_transition=1, allow mbo=1 to be
used to mark the functionality enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-20 20:32:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
114f2830d2 WNM: Ignore WNM-Sleep Mode Request in wnm_sleep_mode=0 case
The hostapd wnm_sleep_mode parameter was previously used to control
advertisement of WNM-Sleep Mode support, but it was not used when
processing a request to use WNM-Sleep Mode. Add an explicit check during
request processing as well so that any misbehaving station is ignored.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-20 17:39:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3d6953288b Extend RESEND_* test commands to allow forcing plaintext TX
This allows hostapd testing functionality to be forced to send out a
plaintext EAPOL-Key frame with the RESEND_* command. That can be useful
in seeing how the station behaves if an unencrypted EAPOL frame is
received when TK is already configured.

This is not really perfect since there is no convenient way of sending
out a single unencrypted frame in the current nl80211 design. The
monitor interface could likely still do this, but that's not really
supposed to be used anymore. For now, clear and restore TK during this
operation. The restore part is not really working correctly, though,
since it ends up clearing the TSC value on the AP side and that shows up
as replay protection issues on the station. Anyway, this is sufficient
to generate sniffer captures to analyze station behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-19 18:32:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4be5bc98a8 DPP: Update AES-SIV AD for PKEX frames
The protocol design was updated to protect the six octets in the header
before the attributes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-19 18:32:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dc4d271c6d DPP: Update AES-SIV AD for DPP Authentication frames
The protocol design was updated to protect the six octets in the header
before the attributes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-18 22:51:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6f234c1e2e Optional AP side workaround for key reinstallation attacks
This adds a new hostapd configuration parameter
wpa_disable_eapol_key_retries=1 that can be used to disable
retransmission of EAPOL-Key frames that are used to install
keys (EAPOL-Key message 3/4 and group message 1/2). This is
similar to setting wpa_group_update_count=1 and
wpa_pairwise_update_count=1, but with no impact to message 1/4
retries and with extended timeout for messages 4/4 and group
message 2/2 to avoid causing issues with stations that may use
aggressive power saving have very long time in replying to the
EAPOL-Key messages.

This option can be used to work around key reinstallation attacks
on the station (supplicant) side in cases those station devices
cannot be updated for some reason. By removing the
retransmissions the attacker cannot cause key reinstallation with
a delayed frame transmission. This is related to the station side
vulnerabilities CVE-2017-13077, CVE-2017-13078, CVE-2017-13079,
CVE-2017-13080, and CVE-2017-13081.

This workaround might cause interoperability issues and reduced
robustness of key negotiation especially in environments with
heavy traffic load due to the number of attempts to perform the
key exchange is reduced significantly. As such, this workaround
is disabled by default (unless overridden in build
configuration). To enable this, set the parameter to 1.

It is also possible to enable this in the build by default by
adding the following to the build configuration:

CFLAGS += -DDEFAULT_WPA_DISABLE_EAPOL_KEY_RETRIES=1

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-17 00:06:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d8afdb210e Allow EAPOL-Key messages 1/4 and 3/4 to be retransmitted for testing
The new hostapd control interface commands "RESEND_M1 <addr>" and
"RESEND_M3 <addr>" can be used to request a retransmission of the 4-Way
Handshake messages 1/4 and 3/4 witht he same or modified ANonce (in M1).

This functionality is for testing purposes and included only in builds
with CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 17:47:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6bc2f00f44 Allow group key handshake message 1/2 to be retransmitted for testing
The new hostapd control interface command "RESEND_GROUP_M1 <addr>" can
be used to request a retransmission of the Group Key Handshake message
1/2 for the current GTK.

This functionality is for testing purposes and included only in builds
with CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 17:47:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
16579769ff Add testing functionality for resetting PN/IPN for configured keys
This can be used to test replay protection. The "RESET_PN" command in
wpa_supplicant and "RESET_PN <addr>" command in hostapd resets the local
counters to zero for the last configured key. For hostapd, the address
parameter specifies which STA this operation is for or selects GTK
("ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff") or IGTK ("ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff IGTK").

This functionality is for testing purposes and included only in builds
with CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 17:43:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a0bf1b68c0 Remove all PeerKey functionality
This was originally added to allow the IEEE 802.11 protocol to be
tested, but there are no known fully functional implementations based on
this nor any known deployments of PeerKey functionality. Furthermore,
PeerKey design in the IEEE Std 802.11-2016 standard has already been
marked as obsolete for DLS and it is being considered for complete
removal in REVmd.

This implementation did not really work, so it could not have been used
in practice. For example, key configuration was using incorrect
algorithm values (WPA_CIPHER_* instead of WPA_ALG_*) which resulted in
mapping to an invalid WPA_ALG_* value for the actual driver operation.
As such, the derived key could not have been successfully set for the
link.

Since there are bugs in this implementation and there does not seem to
be any future for the PeerKey design with DLS (TDLS being the future for
DLS), the best approach is to simply delete all this code to simplify
the EAPOL-Key handling design and to get rid of any potential issues if
these code paths were accidentially reachable.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 02:03:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2f1357fb62 FILS: Accept another (Re)Association Request frame during an association
The previous implementation ended up starting a new EAPOL-Key 4-way
handshake if the STA were to attempt to perform another association.
This resulted in immediate disconnection since the PTK was not ready for
configuring FILS TK at the point when EAPOL-Key msg 1/4 is sent out.
This is better than alloing the association to continue with the same TK
reconfigured, but not really ideal.

Address this potential sequence by not starting a new 4-way handshake on
the additional association attempt. Instead, allow the association to
complete, but do so without reconfiguring the TK to avoid potential
issues with PN reuse with the same TK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 02:03:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
df94906201 Add MGMT_TX_STATUS_PROCESS command for testing purposes
This allows ext_mgmt_frame_handling=1 cases with hostapd to process TX
status events based on external processing. This is useful for increased
test coverage of management frame processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 02:03:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0adc9b28b3 Fix PTK rekeying to generate a new ANonce
The Authenticator state machine path for PTK rekeying ended up bypassing
the AUTHENTICATION2 state where a new ANonce is generated when going
directly to the PTKSTART state since there is no need to try to
determine the PMK again in such a case. This is far from ideal since the
new PTK would depend on a new nonce only from the supplicant.

Fix this by generating a new ANonce when moving to the PTKSTART state
for the purpose of starting new 4-way handshake to rekey PTK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-10-16 02:03:47 +03:00
Mathy Vanhoef
0e3bd7ac68 hostapd: Avoid key reinstallation in FT handshake
Do not reinstall TK to the driver during Reassociation Response frame
processing if the first attempt of setting the TK succeeded. This avoids
issues related to clearing the TX/RX PN that could result in reusing
same PN values for transmitted frames (e.g., due to CCM nonce reuse and
also hitting replay protection on the receiver) and accepting replayed
frames on RX side.

This issue was introduced by the commit
0e84c25434 ('FT: Fix PTK configuration in
authenticator') which allowed wpa_ft_install_ptk() to be called multiple
times with the same PTK. While the second configuration attempt is
needed with some drivers, it must be done only if the first attempt
failed.

Signed-off-by: Mathy Vanhoef <Mathy.Vanhoef@cs.kuleuven.be>
2017-10-16 02:03:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c53eb94616 OWE: Remove forgotten developer debug prints
These were used during initial implementation testing and were not
supposed to get committed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-11 23:43:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2377c1caef SAE: Allow SAE password to be configured separately (AP)
The new sae_password hostapd configuration parameter can now be used to
set the SAE password instead of the previously used wpa_passphrase
parameter. This allows shorter than 8 characters and longer than 63
characters long passwords to be used. In addition, this makes it
possible to configure a BSS with both WPA-PSK and SAE enabled to use
different passphrase/password based on which AKM is selected.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-11 23:10:19 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
91cc34bf32 OWE: Allow set of enabled DH groups to be limited on AP
The new hostapd configuration parameter owe_groups can be used to
specify a subset of the allowed DH groups as a space separated list of
group identifiers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-10 21:03:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8c19ea3f21 DPP: Add the crypto suite field to the frames
This additional field was added to DPP Public Action frames in DPP tech
spec v0.2.3 to support cryptographic agility in the future.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-10 01:30:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c77e2ff096 DPP: Remove C-sign-key expiry
This was removed in DPP tech spec v0.2.3.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-10 01:17:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a891388184 OWE: Transition mode information based on BSS ifname
The owe_transition_bssid and owe_transition_ssid parameters can now be
replace with owe_transition_ifname to clone the BSSID/SSID information
automatically in case the same hostapd process manages both the OWE and
open BSS for transition mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-09 13:39:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d90f10fa41 OWE: PMKSA caching in AP mode
This extends OWE support in hostapd to allow PMKSA caching to be used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-09 12:12:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7a12edd163 OWE: Support DH groups 20 (NIST P-384) and 21 (NIST P-521) in AP mode
This extends OWE support in hostapd to allow DH groups 20 and 21 to be
used in addition to the mandatory group 19 (NIST P-256).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-08 17:12:35 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d8c8d85753 OWE: Include RSNE in (Re)Association Response frame
This is not normally done in RSN, but RFC 8110 seems to imply that AP
has to include OWE AKM in the RSNE within these frames. So, add the RSNE
to (Re)Association Response frames when OWE is being negotiated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-08 17:12:35 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ea079153f4 OWE: Add AP support for transition mode
The new owe_transition_bssid and owe_transition_ssid parameters can be
used to configure hostapd to advertise the OWE Transition Mode element.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-08 17:12:35 +03:00
Peng Xu
4a37463416 hostapd: Update HE capabilities and HE operation definition
Replace vendor-specific elements for HE capabilities and HE operation
elements with the P802.11ax defined element values. This version is
based on P802.11ax/D1.4.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-05 15:09:43 +03:00
bhagavathi perumal s
3567641ebb Add TX/RX rate info and signal strength into STA output
These allow external programs to fetch the TX and RX rate information
and signal strength for a specific STA through the hostapd control
interface command "STA <addr>". The values of these attributes are
filled in the response of nl80211 command NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION.

Signed-off-by: bhagavathi perumal s <bperumal@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-10-05 12:12:24 +03:00
Ilan Peer
fd35ed5bba AP: Remove unneeded check for 'added_unassociated'
In fils_hlp_finish_assoc() the station is already added to the
driver so it is not needed to check the 'added_unassociated'
flag.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2017-09-25 21:21:22 +03:00
Peng Xu
3de1566db8 FILS: Check req_ies for NULL pointer in hostapd_notif_assoc()
Add checking for NULL req_ies when FILS processing a driver ASSOC event
in hostapd_notif_assoc(). This was already done in number of old code
paths, but the newer FILS path did not handle this. Though, it is
unlikely that this code path would be reachable in practice since this
is all within sta->auth_alg == WLAN_AUTH_FILS_* check.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-19 15:28:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6418400db9 Add hostapd tls_flags parameter
This can be used to set the TLS flags for authentication server.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-18 12:12:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5030d7d9fd DPP: Allow raw hex PSK to be used for legacy configuration
The new psk=<hexdump> can be used as an alternative to pass=<passphrase>
when configuring the DPP Configurator with a legacy network parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-15 17:54:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
039ab15fdf DPP: Add DPP-CONFOBJ-PASS/PSK events for hostapd legacy configuration
These control interface event messages can be used to allow hostapd AP
to be configured for legacy WPA2-Personal configuration with DPP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-15 17:45:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9824de57a4 Fix EAPOL-Key version check for a corner case with Suite B AKM
While the Suite B AKM is not really going to be used with CCMP-128 or
GCMP-128 cipher, this corner case could be fixed if it is useful for
some testing purposes. Allow that special case to skip the HMAC-SHA1
check based on CCMP/GCMP cipher and use the following AKM-defined check
instead.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-15 00:36:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4cada9dcc1 FILS: Add DHss into FILS-Key-Data derivation when using FILS SK+PFS
This part is missing from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, but the lack of DHss
here means there would not be proper PFS for the case where PMKSA
caching is used with FILS SK+PFS authentication. This was not really the
intent of the FILS design and that issue was fixed during REVmd work
with the changes proposed in
https://mentor.ieee.org/802.11/dcn/17/11-17-0906-04-000m-fils-fixes.docx
that add DHss into FILS-Key-Data (and PTK, in practice) derivation for
the PMKSA caching case so that a unique ICK, KEK, and TK are derived
even when using the same PMK.

Note: This is not backwards compatible, i.e., this breaks PMKSA caching
with FILS SK+PFS if only STA or AP side implementation is updated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-13 22:17:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
41b8191485 FILS: Update PMKID derivation rules for ERP key hierarchy establishment
IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016 had missed a change in the Pairwise key hierarchy
clause (12.7.1.3 in IEEE Std 802.11-2016) and due to that, the previous
implementation ended up using HMAC-SHA-1 -based PMKID derivation. This
was not really the intent of the FILS design and that issue was fixed
during REVmd work with the changes proposed in
https://mentor.ieee.org/802.11/dcn/17/11-17-0906-04-000m-fils-fixes.docx
that change FILS cases to use HMAC-SHA-256 and HMAC-SHA-384 based on the
negotiated AKM.

Update the implementation to match the new design. This changes the
rsn_pmkid() function to take in the more generic AKMP identifier instead
of a boolean identifying whether SHA256 is used.

Note: This is not backwards compatible, i.e., this breaks PMKSA caching
based on the initial ERP key hierarchy setup if only STA or AP side
implementation is updated. PMKSA caching based on FILS authentication
exchange is not impacted by this, though.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-13 22:17:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
49e6a55537 FILS: Add a space before MAC address to a HLP debug message
The "FILS: No pending HLP DHCP exchange with hw_addr" debug message was
missing a space before the following MAC address, so add that there to
make the message more readable.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-07 13:33:40 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3648d8a185 SAE: Allow commit fields to be overridden for testing purposes
The new sae_commit_override=<hexdump> parameter can be used to force
hostapd to override SAE commit message fields for testing purposes. This
is included only in CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-04 13:32:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e75335384a SAE: Add testing code for reflection attack
Allow hostapd to be configured to perform SAE reflection attack for SAE
testing purposes with sae_reflection_attack=1 configuration parameter.
This is included only in CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-04 13:32:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e61fea6b46 SAE: Fix PMKSA caching behavior in AP mode
Add PMKID into EAPOL-Key 1/4 when using SAE and fix the PMK-from-PMKSA
selection in some cases where PSK (from passphrase) could have been
used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-09-04 13:32:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7475e80f14 FILS: Fix wpa_supplicant AP build without CONFIG_IEEE80211W
CONFIG_FILS was missed as one of items requiring the p pointer in
hostapd_notif_assoc().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-08-24 17:33:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
85fd8263a5 DPP: Use Transaction ID in Peer Discovery Request/Response frames
DPP tech spec changed the contents of these frames by replacing the
public key hash attributes with a Transaction ID attribute that gets
copied from the request to the response to identify the transaction in a
simpler manner.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-08-23 12:51:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a4bf007877 DPP: Remove devices object from the connector
This was removed from the draft DPP tech spec, so remove it from the
implementation as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-08-22 23:46:27 +03:00
Avraham Stern
b5bf84ba39 WNM: Differentiate between WNM for station and for AP in build
Previously, CONFIG_WNM enabled build that supports WNM for both
station mode and AP mode. However, in most wpa_supplicant cases only
station mode WNM is required and there is no need for AP mode WNM.

Add support to differentiate between station mode WNM and AP mode
WNM in wpa_supplicant builds by adding CONFIG_WNM_AP that should be
used when AP mode WNM support is required in addition to station mode
WNM. This allows binary size to be reduced for builds that require
only the station side WNM functionality.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2017-07-18 13:28:09 +03:00
Ashwini Patil
65833d71a5 OCE: Add hostapd mode OCE capability indication if enabled
Add OCE IE in Beacon, Probe Response, and (Re)Association Response
frames if OCE is enabled in the configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-14 21:27:00 +03:00
Naftali Goldstein
3f8e3a5486 ap: Fix invalid HT40 channel pair fallback
In case of incorrect HT40 configuration as part of an attempt to create
a 80 MHz AP, iface->conf->vht_oper_centr_freq_seg0_idx and
iface->conf->vht_oper_centr_freq_seg1_idx are zero'ed, but
iface->conf->vht_oper_chwidth remains VHT_CHANWIDTH_80MHZ. This causes
the logic in dfs_get_start_chan_idx to fail.

Fix this by setting iface->conf->vht_oper_chwidth to
VHT_CHANWIDTH_USE_HT when zero'ing the center frequency parameters.

Signed-off-by: Naftali Goldstein <naftali.goldstein@intel.com>
2017-07-08 16:06:38 +03:00
Ilan Peer
6d3e24d3e3 ap: Fix return value in hostapd_drv_switch_channel()
The documentation in driver.h state that in case of an error
-1 is returned.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2017-07-08 16:06:38 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
bfbc41eace DPP: Fix compilation without openssl
dpp.h file requires openssl in order to compile, which breaks
compilation on systems without it.
Move DPP_OUI_TYPE to ieee802_11_defs.h and don't include dpp.h when
not really needed.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2017-07-07 23:37:45 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
8b5ddda5fb FILS: Add HLP support with driver-based AP SME
This allows HLP processing to postpone association processing in
hostapd_notify_assoc().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-06 15:24:42 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
31ec556cef FILS: Fix the IP header protocol field in HLP DHCP response
The IP header should indicate that UDP is used in the message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-06 14:00:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b3e567c890 FILS: ERP-based PMKSA cache addition on AP
hostapd did not add a new PMKSA cache entry when FILS shared key
authentication was used, i.e., only the initial full authentication
resulted in a PMKSA cache entry being created. Derive the PMKID for the
ERP case as well and add a PMKSA cache entry if the ERP exchange
succeeds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-05 17:52:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bfe448331f FILS: Fix a frame name in a debug print
The EAP message included in FILS Wrapped Data from the non-AP STA to the
AP is EAP-Initiate/Re-auth.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-05 17:29:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a86fb43ca3 DPP: DPP_BOOTSTRAP_INFO for hostapd
This extends the hostapd control interface to support the
DPP_BOOTSTRAP_INFO command that was recently added for wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-04 15:56:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
90f837b0bf Update default wpa_group_rekey to once-per-day when using CCMP/GCMP
The default value for GTK rekeying period was previously hardcoded to
600 seconds for all cases. Leave that short value only for TKIP as group
cipher while moving to the IEEE 802.11 default value of 86400 seconds
(once-per-day) for CCMP/GCMP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-03 13:42:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
787615b381 DPP: Set PMKSA expiration based on peer connector
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-03 13:29:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6b140f0fa2 DPP: Update hostapd configurator parameters to match wpa_supplicant
This updates the previously copied implementation to be up-to-date with
the more recent wpa_supplicant changes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-03 13:15:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2605405aa4 DPP: Configurator in hostapd
This integrates DPP configuration request processing into hostapd GAS
server implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-03 13:03:35 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
efeada91a4 DPP: PKEX in hostapd
Allow hostapd to initiate and respond with PKEX bootstrapping similarly
to how this was implemented in wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-07-03 13:03:34 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4ff89c2ebd DPP: Network Introduction protocol for hostapd
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-19 21:13:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
56c7549587 DPP: AP parameters for DPP AKM
Extend hostapd configuration to include parameters needed for the DPP
AKM: dpp_connector, dpp_netaccesskey, dpp_netaccesskey_expiry,
dpp_csign, dpp_csign_expiry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-19 21:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0c52953b0f DPP: Allow PMKSA cache entries to be added through hostapd ctrl_iface
This allows external programs to generate and add PMKSA cache entries
into hostapd. The main use for this is to run external DPP processing
(network introduction) and testing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-19 21:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
567da5bbd0 DPP: Add new AKM
This new AKM is used with DPP when using the signed Connector to derive
a PMK. Since the KCK, KEK, and MIC lengths are variable within a single
AKM, this needs number of additional changes to get the PMK length
delivered to places that need to figure out the lengths of the PTK
components.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-19 21:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9c2b8204e6 DPP: Integration for hostapd
This adds DPP bootstrapping, authentication, and configuration into
hostapd similarly to how the design was integrated in wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-19 21:13:17 +03:00
Vidyullatha Kanchanapally
115d5e2221 hostapd: Fix handling a 20/40 BSS Coexistence Management frame
hostapd processes a received 20/40 BSS Coexistence management frame, but
if no separate callbacks are registered for handling Public Action
frames it eventually sends a reply with MSB of category code set to 1
thinking that the received frame is an invalid frame. This could happen
based on whether hostapd was built and enabled with functionality using
the callback functions.

Fix this by explicitly returning 1 from the function when the 20/40 BSS
Coexistence Management frame is processed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-06-05 08:04:44 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
2d18ab4082 Add a config parameter to exclude DFS channels from ACS
The new acs_exclude_dfs=1 parameter can be used to request hostapd to
exclude all DFS channels from ACS consideration. This is mainly of use
for cases where the driver supports DFS channels, but for some reason a
non-DFS channel is desired when using automatic channel selection.
Previously, the chanlist parameter could have been used for this, but
that required listing all the acceptable channels. The new parameter
allows this to be done without such a list.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-05-27 11:50:21 +03:00
Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan
04f667fcdd DFS: Allow switch to DFS channel after radar detection in ETSI
This is to comply with uniform spreading requirement for ETSI domain
(section 4.7.2.7 in EN 301 893 - V1.8.1). ETSI uniform spreading
requires equal probability for the usable channels. The previous channel
selection logic after a radar detection did not fully comply with the
uniform spreading requirement for the domain by ignoring DFS channels.
Consider DFS channels also during channel selection when the current DFS
domain is ETSI.

Signed-off-by: Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan <vthiagar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-05-13 20:01:44 +03:00
Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan
aa56e36d66 driver: Make DFS domain information available to core
Current DFS domain information of the driver can be used in ap/dfs
to comply with DFS domain specific requirements like uniform spreading
for ETSI domain.

Signed-off-by: Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan <vthiagar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-05-13 20:01:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8fed47e013 FILS: Derive FT key hierarchy on authenticator side for FILS+FT
Derive PMK-R0 and the relevant key names when using FILS authentication
for initial FT mobility domain association.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-05-07 22:08:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
215eaa748b FILS: Implement FILS-FT derivation
This extends fils_pmk_to_ptk() to allow FILS-FT to be derived. The
callers do not yet use that capability; i.e., actual use will be added
in separate commits.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-05-07 17:04:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
80ddf5d995 FILS: Fix Key-Auth derivation for SK+PFS for authenticator side
The conditional gSTA and gAP (DH public keys) were not previously
included in Key-Auth derivation, but they are needed for the PFS case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-05-07 17:04:29 +03:00
Michael Braun
3a46cf93d0 FT: Add support for wildcard R0KH/R1KH
Enable use of FT RRB without configuring each other AP locally. Instead,
broadcast messages are exchanged to discover APs within the local
network.

When an R0KH or R1KH is discovered, it is cached for one day.

When a station uses an invalid or offline r0kh_id, requests are always
broadcast. In order to avoid this, if r0kh does not reply, a temporary
blacklist entry is added to r0kh_list.

To avoid blocking a valid r0kh when a non-existing pmk_r0_name is
requested, r0kh is required to always reply using a NAK. Resend requests
a few times to ensure blacklisting does not happen due to small packet
loss.

To free newly created stations later, the r*kh_list start pointer in
conf needs to be updateable from wpa_auth_ft.c, where only wconf is
accessed.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2017-05-03 22:16:14 +03:00
Michael Braun
eefe863015 FT RRB: Add msg replay and msg delay protection
This adds a counter and adds sequence numbering to FT RRB packets. The
sequence number is checked against r0kh/r1kh sequence number cache.

Special attention is needed in case the remote AP reboots and thus loses
its state. I prefer it to recover automatically even without synchronized
clocks. Therefore an identifier called dom is generated randomly along the
initial sequence number. If the dom transmitted does not match or the
sequence number is not in the range currently expected, the sender is asked
for a fresh confirmation of its currently used sequence numbers. The packet
that triggered this is cached and processed again later.

Additionally, in order to ensure freshness, the remote AP includes an
timestamp with its messages. It is then verified that the received
messages are indeed fresh by comparing it to the older timestamps
received and the time elapsed since then. Therefore FT_RRB_TIMESTAMP is
no longer needed.

This assigns new OUI 00:13:74 vendor-specific subtype 0x0001 subtypes:
4 (SEQ_REQ) and 5 (SEQ_RESP).

This breaks backward compatibility, i.e., hostapd needs to be updated
on all APs at the same time to allow FT to remain functional.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2017-05-03 22:16:14 +03:00
Michael Braun
245fc96e5f FT: New RRB message format
Convert FT RRB into a new TLV based format. Use AES-SIV as AEAD cipher
to protect the messages.

This needs at least 32 byte long keys. These can be provided either
by a config file change or letting a KDF derive the 32 byte key used
from the 16 byte key given.

This breaks backward compatibility, i.e., hostapd needs to be updated on
all APs at the same time to allow FT to remain functional.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2017-05-03 21:55:29 +03:00
Michael Braun
50bd8e0a90 FT: Replace inter-AP protocol with use of OUI Extended Ethertype
Replace the previously used extension of IEEE 802.11 managed Ethertype
89-0d (originally added for Remote Request/Response in IEEE 802.11r)
with Ethertype 88-b7 (OUI Extended EtherType) for FT inter-AP
communication. The new design uses a more properly assigned identifier
for the messages.

This assigns the OUI 00:13:74 vendor-specific subtype 0x0001 for the new
hostapd AP-to-AP communication purposes. Subtypes 1 (PULL), 2 (RESP),
and 3 (PUSH) are also assigned in this commit for the R0KH-R1KH
protocol.

This breaks backward compatibility, i.e., hostapd needs to be updated on
all APs at the same time to allow FT to remain functional.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2017-05-03 18:30:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f541148257 Fix GAS server ifdef block use
Commit 941caed980 ('MBO: Add MBO
ANQP-element processing on AP') changed the design by using the
rx_anqp_vendor_specific() function to process all ANQP vendor specific
elements. However, the caller for this was within ifdef CONFIG_HS20
block. Fix this by calling the function even in CONFIG_HS20=y is not
included in the build. This fixes CONFIG_MBO=y builds without
CONFIG_HS20=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-05-01 17:39:14 +03:00
Peng Xu
ec27b04e60 hostapd: Select a valid secondary channel if both enabled
When starting AP in HT40 mode and both HT40+ and HT40- options are
specified in hostapd.conf, select a valid secondary channel for the AP
automatically.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-29 16:35:23 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
fa61bff6ae FILS: Handle authentication/association in partial driver AP SME
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-24 01:07:39 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
5cee22ca47 FILS: Make handle_auth_fils() re-usable for driver-based AP SME
Allow this function to be called from outside ieee802_11.c and with the
final steps replaced through a callback function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-24 01:07:39 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
5e5f8c816b FILS: Move authentication response handling into a helper function
This can be reused when splitting handle_auth_fils() to support the
driver-based AP SME case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-24 01:07:36 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
b8a3453aca FILS: Pass only IE area to handle_auth_fils()
This function does not need the frame header, so pass in only the IE
area to make it easier to share this for driver-based AP SME handling.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 18:24:38 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
9392859d7b FILS: Move AssocResp construction to a helper function
This can be reused from driver-based AP SME callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 18:20:00 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
bd59935323 FILS: Move Key Confirm element validation to a helper function
This can be reused from driver-based AP SME callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:55:35 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
087631b985 FILS: Move Session element validation to a helper function
This can be reused from driver-based AP SME callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:47:15 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
cc20edc9f1 FILS: Add FILS auth_alg to driver-based AP SME association handling
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:47:15 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
957bff83c4 FILS: Add driver-AP SME callback to set TK after association
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:47:15 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
8acbf85fa2 FILS: Add FILS AEAD parameters for sta_auth() calls
This is used with partial AP SME in driver cases to enable FILS
association (AES-SIV) processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:47:15 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
6b128fb2af driver: Move sta_auth() arguments to a struct
This makes it easier to add more parameters without having to change the
callback function prototype.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-23 17:47:12 +03:00
Jeffin Mammen
d5444aac4c FILS: Add FILS Indication element into Beacon/Probe Response template
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-04-21 18:44:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5db997e343 FILS: Add FTE into FILS Authentication frame from AP when using FILS+FT
MDE was already added with RSNE, but FTE needed to be added to the FILS
Authentication frame for the FT initial mobility domain association
using FILS authentication case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-04-02 22:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5aa08153af FT: Add selection of FT+FILS AKMs
This is needed to enable use of FILS for the FT initial mobility domain
association.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-04-02 12:57:32 +03:00
Michael Braun
c5fee1604b FT: Schedule wpa_ft_rrb_rx() through eloop in intra-process communication
With AP-AP communication, when hapd0 sends a packet, hapd1 can receive
it immediately and send a response. But hapd0 will only read and process
the response after it has returned from the sending context, that is
entered eloop again. So one does not need to consider the RX function of
the reply to run for the request sending hapd before the send calling
function has returned.

Previously, with intra-process communication, the packet is not
scheduled through eloop. Thus the RX handler of the reply might be run
while the sending context of the original request has not returned.
This might become problematic, e.g., when deferring a management frame
processing until an RRB response is received and then have the request
restarted and finished before the original request handling has been
stopped.

I'm not aware of any concrete bug this is currently triggering but came
across it while thinking of FT RRB AP-AP sequence numbering.

I think the non-eloop scheduling approach might be error-prone and thus
propose to model it more closely to the way the message would be
received from a socket. Additionally, this ensures that the tests model
AP-AP communication more closely to real world.

Solution: queue these packets through eloop.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2017-04-01 12:51:05 +03:00
Mohammed Shafi Shajakhan
775e986d5f hostapd: Fix crash on consecutive channel switch failures
With multiple interface like AP and station which is already
associated to some other AP, when we try to do channel switch
for the AP mode (different from the operation channel support of
station) and if the AP channel switch fails continously (including
the fallback channel switch), results in a crash due to NULL pointer
dereference. This is because hostapd_deinit_driver() assigns the
driver context (drv_priv) to NULL as we are not able to bring up
the interface with a new channel

Signed-off-by: Mohammed Shafi Shajakhan <mohammed@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-29 15:03:16 +03:00
Vidyullatha Kanchanapally
4cc6574d00 FILS: Fix fils_cache_id check
This fixes the following compiler warning:
wpa_auth.c:4249:34: error: address of array 'a->conf.fils_cache_id'
 will always evaluate to 'true' [-Werror,-Wpointer-bool-conversion]

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-26 21:13:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1764559eef FILS: Add FILS SK auth PFS support in AP mode
This adds an option to configure hostapd to enable use of perfect
forward secrecy option in FILS shared key authentication. A new build
option CONFIG_FILS_SK_PFS=y can be used to include this functionality. A
new runtime configuration parameter fils_dh_group is used to enable this
by specifying which DH group to use. For example, fils_dh_group=19 would
allow FILS SK PFS to be used with a 256-bit random ECP group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-12 23:20:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
07a5fe823e OWE: Use AKM 00-0F-AC:11 style parameters for EAPOL-Key frames
draft-harkins-owe-07.txt does not specify these parameters, so need to
pick something sensible to use for the experimental implementation. The
Suite B 128-bit level AKM 00-0F-AC:11 has reasonable parameters for the
DH group 19 case (i.e., SHA256 hash), so use it for now. This can be
updated if the OWE RFC becomes clearer on the appropriate parameters
(KEK/KCK/MIC length, PRF/KDF algorithm, and key-wrap algorithm).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-12 20:43:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ef9627cbc7 Print the algorithms used for EAPOL-Key professing in log
This makes it easier to debug crypto algorithm selection for 4-way
handshake related functions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-12 20:43:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
09368515d1 OWE: Process Diffie-Hellman Parameter element in AP mode
This adds AP side processing for OWE Diffie-Hellman Parameter element in
(Re)Association Request frame and adding it in (Re)Association Response
frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-12 19:24:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a1ea1b4522 OWE: Define and parse OWE AKM selector
This adds a new RSN AKM "OWE".

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-12 19:24:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
941caed980 MBO: Add MBO ANQP-element processing on AP
This extends the GAS server to process MBO ANQP-elements and reply to a
query for the Cellular Data Connection Preference (if configured). The
new configuration parameter mbo_cell_data_conn_pref can be used to set
the value (0, 1, or 255) for the preference to indicate.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-10 18:33:51 +02:00
Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan
7cbb5f1a44 DFS: Handle pre-CAC expired event
As FCC DFS requirement does not explicitly mention about the validity of
the (pre-)CAC when channel is switched, it is safe to assume that the
pre-CAC result will not be valid once the CAC completed channel is
switched or radar detection is not active on the (CAC completed) channel
within a time period which is allowed (10 seconds - channel switch time)
as per FCC DFS requirement.

Use the new driver event to allow the driver to notify expiry of the CAC
result on a channel. Move the DFS state of the channel to 'usable' when
processing pre-CAC expired event.  This means any future operation on
that channel will require a new CAC to be completed. This event is
applicable only when DFS is not offloaded to the kernel driver.

Signed-off-by: Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan <vthiagar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-09 17:01:50 +02:00
Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan
3dcd735c1e DFS: Handle CAC completion event from other radio
When DFS channel state is shared across multiple radios on the system it
is possible that a CAC completion event is propagated from other radio
to us. When in enabled state, do not proceed with setup completion upon
processing CAC completion event with devices where DFS is not offloaded,
when in state other than enabled make sure the configured DFS channel is
in available state before start the AP.

Signed-off-by: Vasanthakumar Thiagarajan <vthiagar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-09 16:46:30 +02:00
Johannes Berg
a1f11e34c4 Use os_memdup()
This leads to cleaner code overall, and also reduces the size
of the hostapd and wpa_supplicant binaries (in hwsim test build
on x86_64) by about 2.5 and 3.5KiB respectively.

The mechanical conversions all over the code were done with
the following spatch:

    @@
    expression SIZE, SRC;
    expression a;
    @@
    -a = os_malloc(SIZE);
    +a = os_memdup(SRC, SIZE);
    <...
    if (!a) {...}
    ...>
    -os_memcpy(a, SRC, SIZE);

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2017-03-07 13:19:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4c803dfcd7 ACS: Fix memory leak if interface is disabled during scan
The survey data was not freed if hostapd interface got disabled during
an ACS scan.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-04 17:30:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
29be2c090e ACS: Simplify code paths
This removes some unnecessarily duplicated return paths and simplifies
code paths.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-04 17:30:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d4359923e1 Fix DHCP/NDISC snoop deinit followed by failing re-init
It was possible to hit a double-free on the l2_packet socket if
initialization of DHCP/NDISC snoop failed on a hostapd interface that
had previously had those enabled successfully. Fix this by clearing the
l2_packet pointers during deinit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-03-04 11:42:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff936bc753 Make the third octet of Country String configurable
The new hostapd.conf parameter country3 can now be used to configure the
third octet of the Country String that was previously hardcoded to ' '
(= 0x20).

For example:

All environments of the current frequency band and country (default)
country3=0x20

Outdoor environment only
country3=0x4f

Indoor environment only
country3=0x49

Noncountry entity (country_code=XX)
country3=0x58

IEEE 802.11 standard Annex E table indication: 0x01 .. 0x1f
Annex E, Table E-4 (Global operating classes)
country3=0x04

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-03-01 10:58:15 +02:00
Peng Xu
5b9f46df0e hostapd: Get channel number from frequency based on other modes as well
When getting the channel number from a frequency, all supported modes
should be checked rather than just the current mode. This is needed when
hostapd switches to a channel in different band.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-26 12:24:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4c8836f139 FILS: Fix fils_hlp.c build with older netinet/udp.h definitions
The __FAVOR_BSD macro was previously used in netinet/udp.h to select
between two different names of the variables in struct udphdr. Define
that to force the versions with the uh_ prefix. In addition, use the
same style consistently within fils_hlp.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-26 12:18:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
57a2aacabf Add option to disable broadcast deauth in hostapd on AP start/stop
The new broadcast_deauth parameter can be used to disable sending of the
Deauthentication frame whenever AP is started or stopped. The default
behavior remains identical to the past behavior (broadcast_deauth=1).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-26 12:05:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
21ed24f5ad hostapd: Fix potential mesh-related change from impacting non-mesh cases
Commit 01e2231fdc ('hostapd: Skip some
configuration steps for mesh cases') removed some operations based on
hapd->iface->mconf being NULL. This was within #ifdef CONFIG_MESH, so it
should not impact hostapd, but it can impact AP mode with
wpa_supplicant. That does not sound intentional, so make these
conditional on hapd->conf->mesh being enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-26 12:05:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7eace3787c FILS: Find PMKSA cache entries on AP based on FILS Cache Identifier
This allows PMKSA cache entries to be shared between all the BSSs
operated by the same hostapd process when those BSSs use the same FILS
Cache Identifier value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-21 12:18:58 +02:00
Peng Xu
d512f406fc hostapd: Add IEEE 802.11ax HE IEs into Beacon/Probe Response frames
IEEE 802.11ax HE changes to include HE IEs in Beacon and Probe Response
frames. These elements are using vendor specific forms for now since the
IEEE 802.11ax draft is not yet finalized and the element contents is
subject to change.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-19 17:37:55 +02:00
Peng Xu
94380cb40a hostapd: Initial IEEE 802.11ax (HE) definitions
Add IEEE 802.11ax definitions for config, IEEE structures, and
constants. These are still subject to change in the IEEE process.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-19 17:37:52 +02:00
Masashi Honma
5972dc73c1 mesh: Use correct rate in VHT and HT mixed environment
Let mesh STA A be a STA which has config disable_ht=0 and disable_vht=1.
Let mesh STA B be a STA which has config disable_ht=0 and disable_vht=0.
The mesh STA A and B was connected.

Previously, the mesh STA A sent frame with VHT rate even though its VHT
was disabled. This commit fixes the issue by checking the local BSS VHT
configuration.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2017-02-19 16:01:17 +02:00
Masashi Honma
84ea61cffe mesh: Use correct rate in HT and legacy mixed environment
Let mesh STA A be a STA which has config disable_ht=1.
Let mesh STA B be a STA which has config disable_ht=0.
The mesh STA A and B was connected.

Previously, the mesh STA A sent frame with HT rate even though its HT
was disabled. This commit fixes the issue by checking the local BSS HT
configuration.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2017-02-19 16:01:17 +02:00
Masashi Honma
a7a638c2c4 hw_features: Move VHT capabilities checks to common
This allows the previous AP-specific functions to be use for IBSS/mesh
setup in wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2017-02-19 15:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a8e25deeb8 FT: Merge similar error paths to use common steps
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-19 12:23:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
834c5d6816 FILS: Fix PMK length for initial connection with FILS SHA384 AKM
While the FILS authentication cases were already using the proper PMK
length (48 octets instead of the old hardcoded 32 octet), the initial
association case had not yet been updated to cover the new FILS SHA384
AKM and ended up using only a 32-octet PMK. Fix that to use 48-octet PMK
when using FILS SHA384 AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-16 22:15:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
364c064a41 FT: Check key derivation results explicitly in AP operations
Previously, any potential (even if very unlikely) local operation error
was ignored. Now these will result in aborting the negotiation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-14 16:33:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
885bbd4de3 WNM: Remove unused code from BSS TM Req generation
The url argument to ieee802_11_send_bss_trans_mgmt_request() was
hardcoded to NULL in the only caller, so this code cannot be reached.
wnm_send_bss_tm_req() construct the same frame with more generic
parameters, including option for including the URL, so
ieee802_11_send_bss_trans_mgmt_request() can be simplified.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-12 17:44:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e7ddd86a98 WNM: Use a common error path in ieee802_11_send_wnmsleep_resp()
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-12 17:44:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d6d5970e23 WNM: Fix WNM-Sleep Mode Request parsing for WNM-Sleep element
The length of the WNM-Sleep element was not verified before using it.
This could result in reading the subfields in this element (total of
four octets) beyond the end of the buffer. Fix this by ignoring the
element if it is not long enough to contain all the subfields.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-12 17:44:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8492cc79c0 PeerKey: Remove dead code related to STSL negotiation state
The struct wpa_stsl_negotiation seemed to have been for some kind of
tracking of state of PeerKey negotiations within hostapd. However,
nothing is actually adding any entries to wpa_auth->stsl_negotiations or
using this state. Since PeerKey does not look like something that would
be deployed in practice, there is no justification to spend time on
making this any more complete. Remove the dead code now instead of
trying to figure out what it might be used for.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-12 11:15:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d60567030 WMM: Fix estimated medium time calculation for some corner cases
It was possible for the int medium_time variable to overflow, so use a
64-bit unsigned integer to get a large enough value for the
multiplication.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-11 12:12:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ae26d30213 Fix "IEEE 802.11: Ignored Action frame" debug message
The arguments to printf were in incorrect order which resulted in
incorrect STA address in the debug message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-11 12:08:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4ead4c7ecd WMM: Remove obsolete TODO comments
These are more about kernel behavior than anything that hostapd would
implement.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-11 10:29:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
401243b73e RRM: Fix range request overriding
This was supposed to cancel the existing eloop timeout instead of
registering another one.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-09 13:26:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fb81c0a3d1 RRM: Merge similar error returns to a single one
There is no need to maintain different return paths for STA being
completely not present and not authorized, so merge these into a single
case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-09 13:26:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
13b30052d9 RRM: Fix Range Request max age parsing
This 16-bit field uses little endian encoding and it must be read with
WPA_GET_LE16() instead of assuming host byte order is little endian. In
addition, this could be misaligned, so using a u16 pointer here was not
appropriate.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-09 13:26:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bd6ec7f7ca Fix MAC ACL query freeing on deinit
hapd->acl_cache and hapd->acl_queries were not reset back to NULL in
hostapd_acl_deinit() when cached results and pending ACL queries were
freed. This left stale pointers to freed memory in hapd. While this was
normally followed by freeing of the hapd data, it is possible to re-use
that hapd when disabling and re-enabling an interface. That sequence
could result in use of freed memory if done while there were cached
results or pending ACL operations with a RADIUS server (especially, if
that server did not reply).

Fix this by setting hapd->acl_queries to NULL when the pending entries
are freed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-08 23:48:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d6dc6830c FILS: Clean up HLP resize check
The "!wpabuf_resize(...) == 0" condition does not make any sense. It
happens to work, but this is really supposed to simple check with
wpabuf_resize() returns non-zero and "wpabuf_resize(...)" is the
cleanest way of doing so.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-07 20:50:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
65ab7eb1fa GAS: Fix OSU Providers List response with invalid configuration
If the OSU Providers configuration was invalid (included osu_server_uri
but not osu_method_list), it was possible for the GAS response
generation to hit a NULL dereference. Fix this by checking for the
invalid configuration before trying to fill in the OSU methods.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-07 17:47:58 +02:00
Günther Kelleter
4bb9b674c8 Add a log message when GTK rekeying failed
It can happen if the station is unreachable or sleeping longer than
the actual total GTK rekey timeout. To fix the latter case
wpa_group_update_count may be increased.

Signed-off-by: Günther Kelleter <guenther.kelleter@devolo.de>
2017-02-07 00:25:36 +02:00
Günther Kelleter
41f140d386 Add hostapd options wpa_group_update_count and wpa_pairwise_update_count
wpa_group_update_count and wpa_pairwise_update_count can now be used to
set the GTK and PTK rekey retry limits (dot11RSNAConfigGroupUpdateCount
and dot11RSNAConfigPairwiseUpdateCount). Defaults set to current
hardcoded value (4).

Some stations may suffer from frequent deauthentications due to GTK
rekey failures: EAPOL 1/2 frame is not answered during the total timeout
period of currently ~3.5 seconds. For example, a Galaxy S6 with Android
6.0.1 appears to go into power save mode for up to 5 seconds. Increasing
wpa_group_update_count to 6 fixed this issue.

Signed-off-by: Günther Kelleter <guenther.kelleter@devolo.de>
2017-02-07 00:25:36 +02:00
Eduardo Abinader
276e936548 hw_features: Clean center freq for falling back HT40 channels
Some channels fail to be set, when falling back to 20 MHz, due to
remaining VHT info of center freq. As we are going to 20 MHz, reset the
VHT center frequency segment information as well.

Signed-off-by: Eduardo Abinader <eduardoabinader@gmail.com>
2017-02-06 19:26:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
84bb12aa6d FILS: Fix send_assoc_resp() HLP extension to cover sta == NULL
Commit 91d91abf6f ('FILS: DHCP relay for
HLP requests') added steps that are conditional on sta->fils_hlp_resp
being non-NULL. One of these cases within send_assoc_resp() was properly
protected from sta == NULL error case (that is now possible after a
recent DMG change), but the first one was not. A DMG error case in a
CONFIG_FILS=y build could have hit a NULL pointer dereference here. Fix
this by verifying sta != NULL more consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-05 16:40:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
caab23f192 Set EAPOL-Key Key Length field to 0 for group message 1/2 in RSN
P802.11i/D3.0 described the Key Length as having value 16 for the group
key handshake. However, this was changed to 0 in the published IEEE Std
802.11i-2004 amendment (and still remains 0 in the current standard IEEE
Std 802.11-2016). We need to maintain the non-zero value for WPA (v1)
cases, but the RSN case can be changed to 0 to be closer to the current
standard.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-05 13:52:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b0fb2be77a Do not send GNonce in EAPOL-Key group message 1/2
While the IEEE Std 802.11-2016 is still indicating that GNonce would be
exchanged in EAPOL-Key messages (see, e.g., Figure 12-52 showing the
Send EAPOL-Key operation in the REKEYNEGOTIATING state or the sample
group key handshake in Figure 12-47), there are also examples of
describing this field as having value zero (e.g., 12.7.7.2 Group key
handshake message 1).

GNonce is used only with the Authenticator and the Supplicant does not
have any use for it, so it is better not to expose that internal value.
Hardcode the Key Nonce field to 0 in EAPOL-Key group message 1/2.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-05 13:39:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3bbc470502 Fix EAPOL-Key Install bit in Group Key 1/2 with FT and FILS auth
sm->Pair needs to be initialized to TRUE since unicast cipher is
supported and this is an ESS. However, the normal place for setting this
(WPA_PTK::INITIALIZE) is skipped with using FT protocol or FILS
authentication, so need to do that separately when forcing PTKINITDONE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-05 13:28:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db5e53cb06 mesh: Fix struct hostapd_data initialization
The local custom version of allocating and initializing struct
hostapd_data within wpa_supplicant_mesh_init() is problematic. This has
already missed couple of initialization steps that are required. Instead
of trying to remember to keep this up to date, use
hostapd_alloc_bss_data() so that there is only one place for this
initialization.

This is fixing a recent issue where FILS HLP started using
hapd->dhcp_server and expected that to be initialized to -1. For the
mesh case, that did not happen and when removing the interface, the FILS
HLP implementation ended up unregistering eloop socket for
hapd->dhcp_server (= 0). This could result in missing socket callbacks
for an arbitrary socket.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-02-04 22:17:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d77f330418 FILS: Fix AES-SIV AAD for (Re)Association Request frame decryption
The hostapd processing of the AES-SIV AAD was incorrect. The design for
the AAD changed between P802.11ai/D7.0 and D8.0 from a single vector
with concatenated data to separate vectors. The change in the
implementation had missed the change in the aes_siv_decrypt() call for
the num_elem parameter. This happened to work with the mac80211
implementation due to a similar error there.

Fix this by using the correct numbers of vectors in the SIV AAD so that
all the vectors get checked. The last vector was also 14 octets too long
due to incorrect starting pointer, so fix that as well. The changes here
are not backwards compatible, i.e., a similar fix in the Linux mac80211
is needed to make things interoperate again.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-04 13:09:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
91d91abf6f FILS: DHCP relay for HLP requests
The new dhcp_server configuration parameter can now be used to configure
hostapd to act as a DHCP relay for DHCPDISCOVER messages received as
FILS HLP requests. The dhcp_rapid_commit_proxy=1 parameter can be used
to configure hostapd to convert 4 message DHCP exchange into a 2 message
exchange in case the DHCP server does not support DHCP rapid commit
option.

The fils_hlp_wait_time parameter can be used to set the time hostapd
waits for an HLP response. This matches the dot11HLPWaitTime in IEEE Std
802.11ai-2016.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-02-01 18:17:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
54b04d6f39 FILS: Move HLP request handling into a separate file
This is independent functionality from the core IEEE 802.11 management
handling and will increase significantly in size, so it is cleaner to
maintain this in a separate source code file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-31 17:46:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5a9d504938 ProxyARP: Use more robust DHCP option parsing
Do not depend on undefined behavior with pointer arithmetic when
checking whether there is sufficient room for an option.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-31 17:46:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e64c13febb Move DHCP definitions into a common file
These can be reused for other purposes than just the DHCP snoofing for
Proxy ARP. In addition, use more complete definition of the parameters
based on the current IANA registry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-31 17:46:11 +02:00
Dedy Lansky
53d171440f AP: Check ACL upon association request for 802.11ad
With device_ap_sme disabled, ACL was checked upon authentication
request. In 802.11ad there is no authentication phase so need to check
ACL upon association.

Signed-off-by: Dedy Lansky <qca_dlansky@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-30 22:22:40 +02:00
Daniel Kim
4cc61c3866 GAS: Set temporary session timeout bigger than gas_comeback_delay
Previously, the temporary STA session timeout was set to 5 seconds. If
gas_comeback_delay is configured to be longer than 5 seconds, GAS
Comeback Response frame can't include queried information as all pending
data has already been cleared due to session timeout. This commit
resolves the issue by setting session timeout to be larger than
gas_comeback_delay.

Signed-off-by: Daniel Kim <kimdan@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-30 13:25:48 +02:00
Johannes Berg
cef8fac04b wpa_auth: Make struct wpa_auth_callbacks const
Instead of copying the struct wpa_auth_callbacks, just keep a pointer to
it, keep the context pointer separate, and let the user just provide a
static const structure. This reduces the attack surface of heap
overwrites, since the function pointers move elsewhere.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2017-01-29 18:41:26 +02:00
Johannes Berg
30eddf3529 Fix or supress various sparse warnings
Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2017-01-29 18:33:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5208160b4b FILS: Parse received FILS HLP requests
This adds parsing of received FILS HLP requests from (Re)Association
Request frames. The reassembled requests are verified to be in valid
format and are printed in debug output. However, actual processing or
forwarding of the packets is not yet implemented, i.e., the vendor
specific frame filtering logic is for now practically dropping all HLP
requests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-29 14:32:17 +02:00
Masashi Honma
4d77d80edd mesh: Add MESH_PMKSA_GET/ADD commands
These commnds are mesh version of PMKSA_GET/ADD commands. So the usage
and security risk is similar to them. Refer to
commit 3459381dd2 ('External persistent
storage for PMKSA cache entries') also.

The MESH_PMKSA_GET command requires peer MAC address or "any" as an
argument and outputs appropriate stored PMKSA cache. And the
MESH_PMKSA_ADD command receives an output of MESH_PMKSA_GET and re-store
the PMKSA cache into wpa_supplicant. By using re-stored PMKSA cache,
wpa_supplicant can skip commit message creation which can use
significant CPU resources.

The output of the MESH_PMKSA_GET command uses the following format:
<BSSID> <PMKID> <PMK> <expiration in seconds>

The example of MESH_PMKSA_ADD command is this.
MESH_PMKSA_ADD 02:00:00:00:03:00 231dc1c9fa2eed0354ea49e8ff2cc2dc cb0f6c9cab358a8146488566ca155421ab4f3ea4a6de2120050c149b797018fe 42930
MESH_PMKSA_ADD 02:00:00:00:04:00 d7e595916611640d3e4e8eac02909c3c eb414a33c74831275f25c2357b3c12e3d8bd2f2aab6cf781d6ade706be71321a 43180

This functionality is disabled by default and can be enabled with
CONFIG_PMKSA_CACHE_EXTERNAL=y build configuration option.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2017-01-14 18:07:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fa67debf4c Fix duplicate Reassociation Request frame dropping
Relational operators (==) have higher precedence than the ternary
conditional in C. The last_subtype check for association/reassociation
was broken due to incorrect assumption about the precedence. Fix this by
adding parenthesis around the ternary conditional.

The previous implementation worked for Association Request frames by
accident since WLAN_FC_STYPE_ASSOC_REQ happens to have value 0 and when
the last receive frame was an Association Request frame, the
sta->last_subtype == reassoc check was true and non-zero
WLAN_FC_STYPE_REASSOC_REQ was interpreted as true. However, this was
broken for Reassociation Request frame. reassoc == 1 in that case could
have matched received Association Response frame (subtype == 1), but
those are not received in AP mode and as such, this did not break other
behavior apart from not being able to drop duplicated Reassociation
Request frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-14 01:04:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fcd3d6ce32 FILS: Fix PMK and PMKID derivation from ERP
This adds helper functions for deriving PMK and PMKID from ERP exchange
in FILS shared key authentication as defined in IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016,
12.12.2.5.2 (PMKSA key derivation with FILS authentication). These
functions is used to fix PMK and PMKID derivation which were previously
using the rMSK directly as PMK instead of following the FILS protocol to
derive PMK with HMAC from nonces and rMSK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-13 21:07:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
167f78a5e8 Send BEACON-REQ-TX-STATUS event only for beacon reports
Check the action TX status callback contents more thoroughly and report
the BEACON-REQ-TX-STATUS event only if the Measurement Type indicates
beacon report.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-07 22:23:13 +02:00
Dedy Lansky
05e5e615e6 AP: Skip authentication/deauthentication phase for DMG/IEEE 802.11ad
Authentication and Deauthentication frames are not used in DMG/IEEE
802.11ad networks. For DMG/IEEE 802.11ad the following was implemented:
Upon receiving association request, allocate the sta object and
initialize it as if authentication took place. Upon receiving
disassociation, deallocate the sta object.
ap_sta_disassociate/ap_sta_deauthenticate/ap_sta_disconnect all use
disassociation instead of deauthentication. In driver_nl80211,
i802_sta_deauth() is routed to i802_sta_disassoc().

Signed-off-by: Dedy Lansky <qca_dlansky@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-05 17:28:23 +02:00
Dedy Lansky
0c4b9025c1 AP: Do not look for supported rates in DMG/IEEE 802.11ad
Supported Rates element is not present in DMG/IEEE 802.11ad frames. Make
copy_supp_rates() immediately return with success if hardware mode is
IEEE 802.11ad.

Signed-off-by: Dedy Lansky <qca_dlansky@qca.qualcomm.com>
2017-01-05 17:05:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ec45927b8a Report received beacon report with BEACON-RESP-RX event
The new hostapd control interface event "BEACON-RESP-RX <STA address>
<dialog token> <report mode> <beacon report>" is now used to report
received beacon reports as a reponse to the REQ_BEACON operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-03 16:02:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f3383366aa Report beacon request TX status as control interface event
The new BEACON-REQ-TX-STATUS control interface event is now used to
report whether a beacon request (from REQ_BEACON command) was delivered
successfully. This event has the following parameters: <STA address>
<dialog token> <ack=0/1>.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-03 16:02:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
90d9d7c32a Beacon request through hostapd control interface
The new control interface command "REQ_BEACON <STA addr>
[req_mode=<mode>] <beacon request>" can now be used to request hostapd
to transmit a measurement request to request a beacon report from an
associated STA. This command returns the assigned dialog token (1-255)
or FAIL on failure.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-03 16:02:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f56877414c Do not add own BSS in neighbor report with invalid op_class/channel
Verify that ieee80211_freq_to_channel_ext() succeeds before adding the
own BSS in the neighbor report.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-03 15:18:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aeff0645d2 FILS: Fix FILS Realm Information ANQP-element construction
The loop to add hash values was supposed to be limited to at most 10000
values, but the count variable was not being decremented in the loop.
Fix this by decrementing counting for each iteration. This fixes
ANQP-element format in the unlikely case of there being more than 10000
configuration realms.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2017-01-03 15:18:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2977f5193a GAS: Remove unnecessarily duplicate gas_frag_limit configuration
The actual BSS configuration parameter can be updated with the SET
control interface command, so there is no need to maintain a separate
per-BSS parameter and a separate control interface handling for this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-30 00:23:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1940559ea4 FT: Drop FT Action frames if ft_over_ds=0
Previously, the hostapd ft_over_ds parameter was used to only advertise
whether FT-over-DS is enabled in MDE and leave it to the stations to
follow that advertisement. This commit extends this to explicitly reject
(silently drop) FT Action frames if a station does not follow the
advertised capabilities.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-29 01:13:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
78022c8366 Fix memory leak on hostapd eap_user_file parsing error paths
Need to free all the pending completed EAP users if a parsing error
prevents the file from being used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-28 14:47:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
95de34a10a Remove trailing whitespace
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-28 14:31:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9266d00bf9 hostapd: Reject invalid macaddr_acl value
Previously, this was noted in error log, but the invalid value was
stored in the configuration without rejecting it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-27 11:43:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1dfd25a68a Fix hostapd SIGHUP processing before interface is enabled
It was possible to try to do driver operations before the driver
interface had been initialized when processing a SIGHUP signal. This
would result in NULL pointer dereference. Fix this by skipping the steps
when SIGHUP is issued before the interface is enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-27 11:16:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
34e29dfd4b Remove unnecessary NULL check from hostapd_config_read_wpa_psk() call
This function is already checking the fname argument against NULL, so
use that check on its own instead of duplicating the check in the only
caller.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-26 17:42:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f0fdaf0e4 Fix race condition between AssocResp callback and 4addr event
It is apparently possible for the NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME
event to be delivered to hostapd before the NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS
event for (Re)Association Response frame. This resulted in the 4-address
WDS mode not getting enabled for a STA. This could occur in particular
when operating under heavy load and the STA is reconnecting to the same
AP in a sequence where Deauthentication frame is followed immediately by
Authentication frame and the driver event processing gets delayed due to
removal of the previous netdev taking time in the middle of this
sequence.

Fix this by recording a pending item for 4-address WDS enabling if the
NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME event would have been dropped due to
incompleted association and then process this pending item if the TX
status for the (Re)Association Response frame is received and it shows
that the frame was acknowledged.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-12-20 01:30:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8183aee6cc FILS: Add support for building FILS Realm Information ANQP-element
This allows full list of hashed realm names to be fetched from hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-18 11:41:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
26bf70e3d2 FILS: Separate FILS realm configuration from ERP domain
The new hostapd configuration parameter fils_realm=<realm> can now be
used to configure one or more FILS realms to advertise for ERP domains
when using FILS. This replaces the use of erp_domain=<domain> parameter
for the FILS use case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-17 22:08:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
42b847ac1e FILS: Fix hashed realm name derivation
P802.11ai/D7.0 changed from CRC32 to SHA256 as the hash algorithm for
the FILS realm name. Update the implementation to match that change.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-17 22:07:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cebda0e3e5 Make debug print clearer for AP/mesh mode secondary channel issues
If the secondary channel was not found at all, no debug print was shown
to indicate that the channel was rejected due to that problem. Print a
clearer message indicating which channel was behind the reason to reject
channel configuration as unsuitable for AP mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-12-13 15:09:15 +02:00
Daisuke Niwa
655dc4a432 Send "TERMINATING" event from hostapd
hostapd didn't send "TERMINATING" event when stopped by
SIGTERM. Android handles this event to stop monitor thread.

This commit adds "TERMINATING" event same as with wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Tomoharu Hatano <tomoharu.hatano@sonymobile.com>
2016-12-12 20:32:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0f5eb69f85 Use eloop timeout for post-EAP-Failure wait before disconnection
Previously, os_sleep() was used to block the hostapd (or wpa_supplicant
AP/P2P GO mode) processing between sending out EAP-Failure and
disconnecting the STA. This is not ideal for couple of reasons: it
blocks all other parallel operations in the process and it leaves a
window during which the station might deauthenticate and the AP would
have no option for reacting to that before forcing out its own
Deauthentication frame which could go out after the STA has already
started new connection attempt.

Improve this design by scheduling an eloop timeout of 10 ms instead of
the os_sleep() call and perform the delayed operations from the eloop
callback function. This eloop timeout is cancelled if the STA
disconnects or initiates a new connection attempt before the 10 ms time
is reached. This gets rid of the confusing extra Deauthentication frame
in cases where the STA reacts to EAP-Failure by an immediate
deauthentication.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-12-08 18:56:02 +02:00
Michael Braun
34f7c699a6 Add multicast to unicast support
This adds support for nl80211 NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST
command.

By setting the new hostapd configuration option multicast_to_unicast=1,
hostapd configures this AP to perform multicast to unicast conversion.

When enabled, all multicast packets with ethertype ARP, IPv4, or IPv6
(possibly within an 802.1Q header) will be sent out to each station once
with the destination (multicast) MAC address replaced by the station's
MAC address. Note that this may break certain expectations of the
receiver, e.g., the ability to drop unicast IP packets encapsulated in
multicast L2 frames, or the ability to not send destination unreachable
messages in such cases.

This also does not implement Directed Multicast Service (DMS).

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-12-04 21:00:06 +02:00
Sam Tannous
08032c7418 Remove inactivity timeout for wired interfaces
We should unconditionally remove inactivity timers for wired network
cases. This commit checks for this after a new station association:

   hapd->iface->drv_flags & WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_WIRED

and then cancels the timeout and does not register a new one.

It prints out a debug message like this:

1476740180.276286: IEEE 802.1X: 00:02:00:00:00:07 CTRL_DIR entering
state FORCE_BOTH
1476740180.276295: hostapd_new_assoc_sta: canceled wired ap_handle_timer
timeout for 00:02:00:00:00:07

This was tested on a debian jessie amd64 system with a configured 120
second inactivity timer and the session did not timeout.

Signed-off-by: Sam Tannous <stannous@cumulusnetworks.com>
2016-12-04 20:38:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cb2b666670 Fix 4addr reassociation-without-deauthentication on AP
Data connection was lost if a station reassociated without the STA entry
being cleaned up on the AP side. Fix this by moving reconfiguration of
the STA WDS parameters in association response callback to happen only
after the STA flags have been updated to associated stated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-12-02 12:51:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2ab09656ae AP: Do not drop STA entry if PMF is used with full AP client state
This fixes a regression from commit
bb598c3bdd ('AP: Add support for full
station state'). That commit added code to remove and re-add the kernel
STA entry when processing Authentication frames with a driver that
advertises support for full AP client state. That resulted in bypassing
PMF protections for unprotected Authentication frames with such drivers
since the TK was lost in this operation.

It is simplest to skip the STA entry clearing in this type of case
completely to leave the TK in place and to process the new
authentication exchange otherwise normally. This matches the behavior
used with the drivers that do not implement full AP client state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-11-29 16:26:00 +02:00
Will Glynn
209dad066e FT: Explicitly check for MDE not present in non-FT association
IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 12.4.2 states that if an MDE is present in an
(Re)Association Request frame but the RSNE uses a non-FT AKM suite, the
AP shall reject the association using status code 43 ("Invalid AKMP").

wpa_validate_wpa_ie() now explicitly checks for this condition to meet
this requirement instead of simply ignoring the MDE based on non-FT AKM.

Signed-off-by: Will Glynn <will@willglynn.com>
2016-11-26 11:39:44 +02:00
Purushottam Kushwaha
29483a5678 Add support for user configurable Beacon frame data rate for AP mode
Allow configuration of Beacon frame TX rate from hostapd.conf with
"beacon_rate=xx" option. The following format is used to set
legacy/HT/VHT beacon rates:

Legacy (CCK/OFDM rates):
	beacon_rate=<legacy rate in 100 kbps>
HT:
	beacon_rate=ht:<HT MCS>
VHT:
	beacon_rate=vht:<VHT MCS>

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-11-25 23:12:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4051dd8667 GAS: Add Capability List ANQP-element support for Info ID 270, 280..299
This extends the anqp_elem configuration parameter support for new Info
IDs (270 (TDLS Capability) was previously missed from the list of
defined values, 280 has already been assigned in REVmc/D8.0; 281..299
are yet to be assigned). No additional source code changes are needed to
allow hostapd to advertise support for these if the ANQP-element value
is set with the anqp_elem parameter.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-11-17 16:00:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d50f518e95 Fix libap.a build
Add the new defines and files to allow src/ap/libap.a to be build with
all the needed functions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-11-16 13:26:23 +02:00
Ilan Peer
4ec1fd8e42 FT: Differentiate between FT for station and for AP in build
Previously, CONFIG_IEEE80211R enabled build that supports FT for both
station mode and AP mode. However, in most wpa_supplicant cases only
station mode FT is required and there is no need for AP mode FT.

Add support to differentiate between station mode FT and AP mode FT in
wpa_supplicant builds by adding CONFIG_IEEE80211R_AP that should be used
when AP mode FT support is required in addition to station mode FT. This
allows binary size to be reduced for builds that require only the
station side FT functionality.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2016-10-29 22:14:54 +03:00
Beni Lev
f0259c3f68 hostapd: Fix own wide bandwidth subelement generation (neighbor report)
The Channel Center Frequency Segment subfields use the channel index
instead of frequency in MHz.

Signed-off-by: Beni Lev <beni.lev@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-10-29 22:03:43 +03:00
Ilan Peer
0a63635ed0 AP: Use valid status code in wpa_ft_send_rrb_auth_resp()
The return value from this function may be used in an outgoing message,
so use a valid status code instead of -1.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2016-10-29 22:02:14 +03:00
David Spinadel
451a27b1ad hostapd: Add a configuration to set an AP as stationary
Add a configuration option in hostapd.conf and in neighbor report that
sets an AP as stationary. To enable this option on the current AP set
the config option stationary_ap to 1. To set a neighbor entry to be
marked as stationary add the word stat to the SET_NEIGHBOR command. This
option tells hostapd to send LCI data even if it is older than requested
by max age subelement in RRM request.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-10-29 19:16:47 +03:00
Ilan Peer
f5ec346902 hostapd: Fix adding neighbor entry
It is possible that a LCI or location civic configuration buffer
is valid but contains no data. In such a case do not add the LCI
and location civic information to the entry in the neighbor
data base.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2016-10-29 19:10:17 +03:00
Filip Matusiak
59d7cff7e3 AP: Disable VHT in TKIP-only configuration
This has already been done for WEP, but there's same constraint for not
allowing VTH rates in case of TKIP.

Signed-off-by: Filip Matusiak <filip.matusiak@tieto.com>
2016-10-29 00:55:49 +03:00
Kevin Mahoney
a818425d1c hostapd: Added signal level to STA tracking
Add signal level information to the station tracking information. Also
make it available via the "TRACK_STA_LIST" control command.

Signed-off-by: Kevin Mahoney <k.mahoney@cablelabs.com>
2016-10-29 00:55:49 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
5f99d96287 Removed redundant NULL check for sta in hostapd_event_sta_low_ack()
Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2016-10-28 19:06:20 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2a0b86d319 Note set_key(WPA_ALG_NONE) failure in debug log
This makes wpa_remove_ptk() call to wpa_auth_set_key() more consistent
with all the other calls that verify the return value to keep static
analyzers happier.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-26 00:41:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ff338fab92 FILS: Setup EAPOL state machines properly after FILS association (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-26 00:41:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
da24c5aa1c FILS: Set TK after association (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-26 00:41:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
07e0117d21 FILS: Mark connection fully authorized after FILS Association (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-26 00:20:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e73ffa0925 FILS: Add Association Response frame elements and encrypt them (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-25 20:42:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
78815f3dde FILS: Decrypt Association Request elements and check Key-Auth (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-25 20:42:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c4fd6d8aa8 FILS: Process FILS Authentication frame (AP)
This implements processing of FILS Authentication frame for FILS shared
key authentication with ERP and PMKSA caching.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 23:27:01 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ffb62f2272 FILS: Add a helper function for status code conversion
This will allow the existing code to be reused for FILS needs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 23:27:01 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c1bd4bac5f FILS: Extend wpa_auth_pmksa_get() to support PMKID matching
This is needed for FILS processing to enable PMKSA caching.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 23:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c30bd28b14 FILS: Export IEEE 802.1X helper functions
ieee802_1x_encapsulate_radius() and ieee802_1x_alloc_eapol_sm() need to
be called from FILS processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 23:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a6228b8ed6 ERP: Update client identity based on EAP-Initiate/Re-auth
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 23:13:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2aa1e48a45 FILS: Do not clear PTK on FILS Auth/Assoc (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-22 18:11:14 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2449791b8e FILS: Update EAPOL-Key Descriptor Version RX rules (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
75c8563e05 FILS: Perform AEAD processing after PTK has been confirmed
This covers EAPOL-Key frames other than 2/4 that needed special handling
to confirm PTK.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b729fd8df9 FILS: Use AEAD cipher to protect EAPOL-Key frames (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3b5b7aa8fb FILS: Use AEAD cipher to check received EAPOL-Key frames (AP)
This changes 4-way handshake authenticator processing to decrypt the
EAPOL-Key frames using an AEAD cipher (AES-SIV with FILS AKMs) before
processing the Key Data field. This replaces Key MIC validation for the
cases where AEAD cipher is used. This needs to move the EAPOL-Key msg
2/4 RSN element processing to happen only after the PTK has been derived
and validated. That is done for all AKMs to avoid extra complexity with
having to maintain two code paths for this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b986648389 FILS: Update EAPOL-Key RX rules for FILS (AP)
Key Descriptor Version 0 is used with FILS and Key Info MIC field is set
to 0 with AEAD ciphers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
36a50fd4e8 FILS: Set EAPOL-Key Key Descriptor Version to 0 with FILS AKMs (AP)
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dc5bad48af RSN authenticator: Add more debug print details on EAPOL-Key RX
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6d014ffc6e Make struct wpa_eapol_key easier to use with variable length MIC
Suite B 192-bit addition from IEEE Std 802.11ac-2013 replaced the
previous fixed length Key MIC field with a variable length field. That
change was addressed with an addition of a new struct defined for the
second MIC length. This is not really scalable and with FILS coming up
with a zero-length MIC case for AEAD, a more thorough change to support
variable length MIC is needed.

Remove the Key MIC and Key Data Length fields from the struct
wpa_eapol_key and find their location based on the MIC length
information (which is determined by the AKMP). This change allows the
separate struct wpa_eapol_key_192 to be removed since struct
wpa_eapol_key will now include only the fixed length fields that are
shared with all EAPOL-Key cases in IEEE Std 802.11.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
94f66e8a26 FILS: Advertise ERP domain in FILS Indication element
Calculate the hashed realm from hostapd erp_domain configuration
parameter and add this to the FILS Indication element when ERP is
enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c30ed45f45 FILS: Allow hostapd to select FILS AKM for connection
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f55acd909e FILS: Set FILS Capability bit in management frames from AP
If FILS is enabled, indicate that in Beacon, Probe Response, and
(Re)Association Response frames in the Extended Capabilities element.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
198a942c83 FILS: Add FILS Indication element to Beacon and Probe Response frames
If FILS is enabled, indicate that in AP Beacon/Probe Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
903ecbe8da FILS: Add hostapd configuration options
This adds CONFIG_FILS=y build configuration option and new key
management options for FILS authentication.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 21:11:27 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
94318a0d30 FILS: Add AKM definitions
This adds definitions for the new AKM suite values from P802.11ai/D11.0.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-10-10 20:46:36 +03:00
Michael Braun
96590564d6 FT: Allow PMK-R0 and PMK-R1 for FT-PSK to be generated locally
Station should be able to connect initially without ft_pmk_cache filled,
so the target AP has the PSK available and thus the same information as
the origin AP. Therefore neither caching nor communication between the
APs with respect to PMK-R0 or PMK-R1 or VLANs is required if the target
AP derives the required PMKs locally.

This patch introduces the generation of the required PMKs locally for
FT-PSK. Additionally, PMK-R0 is not stored (and thus pushed) for FT-PSK.

So for FT-PSK networks, no configuration of inter-AP communication is
needed anymore when using ft_psk_generate_local=1 configuration. The
default behavior (ft_psk_generate_local=0) remains to use the pull/push
protocol.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-10-09 11:57:56 +03:00
Nishant Chaprana
746e5c2565 Fix spelling mistakes in number of comments
Signed-off-by: Nishant Chaprana <n.chaprana@samsung.com>
2016-09-30 22:45:03 +03:00
vamsi krishna
64c92c0757 MBO: Do not parse reason_detail in non_pref_chan attr (AP)
The reason detail field was removed from non_pref_chan attr in MBO
v0.0_r25 draft. Don't parse for this element to be compliant with the
latest drafr.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-09-25 17:31:26 +03:00
Denton Gentry
442819406c taxonomy: Store Probe Request frames in hostapd_sta_info
A weakness in the initial client taxonomy mechanism is from storing both
the Probe and Associate in struct sta_info. struct sta_info is created
after a client associates (or starts authentication frame exchange),
which means that any Probe Request frames sent prior to association are
not retained. The Associate Request frame has to be seen, and then
another Probe Request frame after association, before we have a
signature for the client.

Most clients send lots of Probe Request frames (lots and lots and lots
of Probes, actually), but a few do not. ChromeOS is notably sparing in
sending Probe Request frames, it can take a long time before a signature
for a ChromeOS device is available.

Store the most recent Probe Request frame in struct hostapd_sta_info
tracking list. When a struct sta_info is created, move the Probe Request
frame information from struct hostapd_sta_info to struct sta_info.

Signed-off-by: dgentry@google.com (Denton Gentry)
Signed-off-by: denny@geekhold.com (Denton Gentry)
Signed-off-by: rofrankel@google.com (Richard Frankel)
Signed-off-by: richard@frankel.tv (Richard Frankel)
2016-09-22 00:45:24 +03:00
Denton Gentry
04059ab844 Passive Client Taxonomy
Implement the signature mechanism described in the paper
"Passive Taxonomy of Wifi Clients using MLME Frame Contents"
published by Denton Gentry and Avery Pennarun.

http://research.google.com/pubs/pub45429.html
https://arxiv.org/abs/1608.01725

This involves:
1. Add a CONFIG_TAXONOMY compile option. Enabling taxonomy incurs
   a memory overhead of up to several kilobytes per associated
   station.
2. If enabled, store the Probe Request and (Re)Associate Request frame in
   struct sta_info.
3. Implement code to extract the ID of each Information Element,
   plus selected fields and bitmasks from certain IEs, into a
   descriptive text string. This is done in a new source file,
   src/ap/taxonomy.c.
4. Implement a "signature qq:rr:ss:tt:uu:vv" command
   in hostapd_cli to retrieve the signature.

Signatures take the form of a text string. For example, a signature
for the Nexus 5X is:
  wifi4|probe:0,1,127,45,191,htcap:01ef,htagg:03,htmcs:0000ffff,vhtcap:338061b2,
  vhtrxmcs:030cfffa,vhttxmcs:030cfffa,extcap:00000a0201000040|assoc:0,1,48,45,
  221(0050f2,2),191,127,htcap:01ef,htagg:03,htmcs:0000ffff,vhtcap:339071b2,
  vhtrxmcs:030cfffa,vhttxmcs:030cfffa,extcap:0000000000000040

Signed-off-by: dgentry@google.com (Denton Gentry)
Signed-off-by: denny@geekhold.com (Denton Gentry)
Signed-off-by: rofrankel@google.com (Richard Frankel)
Signed-off-by: richard@frankel.tv (Richard Frankel)
2016-09-22 00:45:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5e993390f6 Initialize iface->sta_seen on allocation
Previously, struct hostapd_iface sta_seen list head was initialized only
when completing interface setup. This left a window for operation that
could potentially iterate through the list before the list head has been
initialized. While the existing code checked iface->num_sta_seen to
avoid this case, it is much cleaner to initialize the list when struct
hostapd_iface is allocated to avoid any accidental missing of the extra
checks before list iteration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-09-22 00:45:24 +03:00
Nick Lowe
81258efacb Remove unused generation of Request Authenticator in Account-Request
Do not generate an unused and invalid Request Authenticator (random
value) when constructing Accounting-Request packets. The correct Request
Authenticator is calculated subsequently in radius_msg_finish_acct()
using MD5(msg + shared secret).

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-09-22 00:34:19 +03:00
Joel Cunningham
711e3cab07 Handle NULL return from os_zalloc() in sta_track_add()
This adds handling for a memory allocation failure in sta_track_add().

Signed-off-by: Joel Cunningham <joel.cunningham@me.com>
2016-09-06 18:58:08 +03:00
Lior David
faecb39236 hostapd: Allow FTM functionality to be published
Add configuration options that control publishing of fine timing
measurement (FTM) responder and initiator functionality via bits 70, 71
of Extended Capabilities element. Typically, FTM functionality is
controlled by a location framework outside hostapd. When framework is
activated, it will use hostapd to configure the AP to publish the FTM
functionality. See IEEE P802.11-REVmc/D7.0, 9.4.2.27.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-09-05 21:23:07 +03:00
Tamizh chelvam
fc72a48a63 hostapd: Use stations nsts capability in (Re)Association Response frame
Some deployed stations incorrectly consider nsts capability in
(Re)Association Response frame as required capability instead of maximum
capability and if it is greater than station's capability then beamform
will not happen in uplink traffic.

This commit adds support for an optional workaround to use station's
nsts capability in (Re)Association Response frame if the station's nsts
is less than AP by using the use_sta_nsts=1 configuration parameter.
This configuration is introduced in this commit and it is disabled by
default.

Signed-off-by: Tamizh chelvam <c_traja@qti.qualcomm.com>
2016-09-05 21:14:40 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f2f8616e80 Initialize hapd->nr_db in hostapd_alloc_bss_data()
Previously, this was initialized in hostapd_setup_bss() which made it
possible for a REMOVE_NEIGHBOR control interface command to be issued
prior to the list head pointers having been set. That resulted in a NULL
pointer dereference. Fix this by initializing the list head at the time
the data structure gets allocated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-08-22 17:44:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1f3b8b4edb Check for driver initialization before doing driver operations
Number of hostapd control interface commands (e.g., STATUS-DRIVER) could
result in NULL pointer dereference when issued on not yet enabled BSS.
Fix this by checking that the driver interface has been initialized
before calling the driver_ops function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-08-19 16:08:00 +03:00
Petko Bordjukov
72a652d785 IAPP: Set SO_REUSEADDR on listening socket
Make it possible for several instances of hostapd to listen on the same
network interface.

Signed-off-by: Petko Bordjukov <bordjukov@gmail.com>
2016-08-18 20:01:48 +03:00
Johannes Berg
81372e347a ap: Use is_multicast_ether_addr() more
Various checks should use is_multicast_ether_addr() instead
of hardcoding the equivalent, change it.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2016-08-17 13:43:31 +03:00
Nick Lowe
8468189e90 Do not include NAS-Port attribute with AID 0
Do not include a NAS-Port attribute in Access-Request and
Accounting-Request packets where the Association ID (AID) is 0, i.e.,
not yet assigned or known.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-08-13 10:28:01 +03:00
Nick Lowe
42d30e9ea0 Add a require_message_authenticator configuration option
This can be used to mandate the presence of the Message-Authenticator
attribute on CoA/Disconnect-Request packets.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-08-08 00:36:17 +03:00
Johannes Berg
842c5af5d3 ap: Use is_broadcast_ether_addr()
There's no need to have a separate variable and open-code a more
complicated version of this, just use is_broadcast_ether_addr().

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2016-08-06 16:51:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e55df99ee6 Share a single str_starts() implementation
No need to define this as a static function in multiple files.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-08-06 12:38:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5a5638a3bf Show disabled HT/VHT properly in AP mode STATUS command
Previously, HT/VHT state was shown in STATUS based on the configuration
parameter instead of the runtime operational parameters. This could
result in claiming HT/VHT to be enabled even when it was forced to be
disabled due to an incompatible configuration. Clear HT/VHT information
in the STATUS output if HT/VHT has been disabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-08-02 17:41:01 +03:00
Wu Gao
551817a582 AP: Disable VHT in WEP configuration
This was already done for HT, but VHT has the same constraint on not
allowing WEP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-08-02 17:31:48 +03:00
Masashi Honma
e347cafe57 mesh: Report mesh peer AID to kernel
Previously, mesh power management functionality works only with kernel
MPM. Because user space MPM did not report mesh peer AID to kernel,
the kernel could not identify the bit in TIM element. So this patch
reports mesh peer AID to kernel.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-07-23 20:26:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d735811329 tests: Add TEST_FAIL() to hostapd_get_aid()
This allows additional testing coverage for AID unavailability cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-28 20:44:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ebae413550 Fix a debug print in p2p_manager_disconnect()
fc2str() expects to get the 16-bit frame control value in host byte
order.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-24 19:02:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
451e094c7e dhcp_snoop: Silence a sparse warning
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-24 19:02:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bbae0f03aa ndisc_snoop: Include ndisc_snoop.h to check prototypes
This allows the compiler to check that function prototypes match the
implementation. In addition, this gets rid of sparse warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-24 19:02:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
468b7b12a6 Fix hostapd_sta_add() call to use NULL as the pointer instead of 0
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-23 13:14:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3b6deac0e7 mesh: Avoid use of hardcoded cipher
This moves pairwise, group, and management group ciphers to various mesh
data structures to avoid having to hardcode cipher in number of places
through the code. While CCMP and BIP are still the hardcoded ciphers,
these are now set only in one location.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-19 20:18:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f868d5607d mesh: Clean up AMPE element encoding and parsing
The AMPE element includes number of optional and variable length fields
and those cannot really be represented by a fixed struct
ieee80211_ampe_ie. Remove the optional fields from the struct and
build/parse these fields separately.

This is also adding support for IGTKdata that was completely missing
from the previous implementation. In addition, Key RSC for MGTK is now
filled in and used when configuring the RX MGTK for a peer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-19 20:18:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4367eec439 mesh: Do not use RX MGTK as RX IGTK
The previous implementation was incorrect in forcing the MGTK to be used
as the IGTK as well. Define new variable for storing IGTK and use that,
if set, to configure IGTK to the driver. This commit does not yet fix
AMPE element parsing to fill in this information.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-19 20:18:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a4eec3c230 mesh: Use variable length MGTK for RX
This extends the data structures to allow variable length MGTK to be
stored for RX. This is needed as an initial step towards supporting
different cipher suites.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-19 20:18:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b02f4d058c mesh: Add variable length MTK support
This is needed as a part in enabling support for different pairwise
ciphers in mesh.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-19 20:18:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
18aca1a07d mesh: Use ieee80211w profile parameter
This is initial step in fixing issues in how PMF configuration for RSN
mesh was handled. PMF is an optional capability for mesh and it needs to
be configured consistently in both hostapd structures (to get proper
RSNE) and key configuration (not included in this commit).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-18 15:52:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b8b499e4a4 mesh: Use WPA_NONCE_LEN macro
No need to use the magic value 32 here since there is a generic define
for the RSN-related nonce values.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-18 15:52:54 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
bb4e19e3f4 hostapd: Skip hostapd ACL check for drivers supporting ACL offload
Commit 0603bcb7fe ('hostapd: Process MAC
ACLs on a station association event (SME in driver)') processes MAC ACL
on a station association event for drivers which use AP SME offload but
does not consider the scenario where the drivers offload ACL. This can
result in station disconnection, though the driver accepts the
connection. Address this by avoiding the hostapd ACL check for the
drivers offloading MAC ACL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-17 20:45:35 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cc27c8e680 hostapd: Fix early init failure path
eloop deinit calls could trigger segmentation fault if the early error
path is hit before eloop_init() gets called.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-06-13 00:37:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8359472589 hostapd Make GAS Address3 field selection behavior configurable
gas_address3=1 can now be used to force hostapd to use the IEEE 802.11
standards compliant Address 3 field value (Wildcard BSSID when not
associated) even if the GAS request uses non-compliant address (AP
BSSID).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-10 22:13:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6996ff7b6d hostapd: Fix Public Action frame TX status processing for wildcard BSSID
Previously all TX status events with wildcard BSSID were ignored. This
did not allow Public Action frame TX status to be processed with the
corrected wildcard BSSID use. Fix this to be allowed. In practice, this
affects only test cases since Action frame TX status was not used for
anything else.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-10 21:44:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
78a3632765 hostapd: Fix Public Action frame addressing (BSSID field)
IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 10.19 (Public Action frame addressing) specifies
that the wildcard BSSID value is used in Public Action frames that are
transmitted to a STA that is not a member of the same BSS. hostapd used
to use the actual BSSID value for all such frames regardless of whether
the destination STA is a member of the BSS.

Fix this by using the wildcard BSSID in cases the destination STA is not
a member of the BSS. Leave group addressed case as-is (i.e., the actual
BSSID), since both values are accepted. No such frames are currently
used, though.

This version is still using the AP BSSID value in the Address 3 field
for GAS response frames when replying to a GAS request with AP BSSID
instead of Wildcard BSSID. This is left as a workaround to avoid
interoperability issues with deployed STA implementations that are still
using the non-compliant address and that might be unable to process the
standard compliant case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-06-10 21:44:49 +03:00
Kanchanapally, Vidyullatha
cc9a2575ca nl80211: Use extended capabilities per interface type
This adds the necessary changes to support extraction and use of the
extended capabilities specified per interface type (a recent
cfg80211/nl80211 extension). If that information is available,
per-interface values will be used to override the global per-radio
value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-05-31 21:35:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dad0129227 mesh: Support simple SAE group negotiation case
This allows the simplest case of SAE group negotiation to occur by
selecting the next available group if the peer STA indicates the
previous one was not supported. This is not yet sufficient to cover all
cases, e.g., when both STAs need to change their groups, but at least
some cases are no covered.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-05-30 21:14:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9c10be3f71 mesh: Fix error path handling in init OOM cases
hostapd deinit functions were not ready to handle a case where the data
structures were not fully initialized. Make these more robust to allow
wpa_supplicant mesh implementation to use the current deinit design in
OOM error cases without causing NULL pointer dereferences.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-05-30 01:05:16 +03:00
Bala Krishna Bhamidipati
a911227061 Add assocresp_elements parameter for hostapd
This new parameter allows hostapd to add Vendor Specific elements into
(Re)Association Response frames similarly to the way vendor_elements
parameter can be used for Beacon and Probe Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-04-20 13:12:50 +03:00
Günther Kelleter
b92d2a57ef FT: Fix RRB for FT over-the-air case
Commit 66d464067d ('FT: Register RRB
l2_packet only if FT-over-DS is enabled') disabled RRB l2_packet socket
if ft_over_ds is disabled, but this socket is required for FT
over-the-air, too (FT key distribution). Enable the socket regardless of
ft_over_ds setting if FT is enabled.

Signed-off-by: Günther Kelleter <guenther.kelleter@devolo.de>
2016-04-19 00:57:17 +03:00
David Spinadel
220754c553 hostapd: Add FTM range request
Add FTM range request via RRM. The AP sends Radio measurement request
with FTM range request as a request for the receiving STA to send FTM
requests to the given list of APs. The neighbor report part of the
request is taken from the neighbor database.

The control interface command is:

REQ_RANGE <dst addr> <rand_int> <min_ap> <responder> [<responder>..]

dst addr: MAC address of an associated STA
rand_int: Randomization Interval (0..65535) in TUs
min_ap: Minimum AP Count (1..15); minimum number of requested FTM ranges
	between the associated STA and the listed APs
responder: List of BSSIDs for neighboring APs for which a measurement
	is requested

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-17 12:29:12 +03:00
David Spinadel
f4f185a224 hostapd: Add LCI request
Add a hostapd control interface command REQ_LCI to request LCI from an
associated station using radio measurement.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-17 12:29:12 +03:00
David Spinadel
629e1804da hostapd: Save RM enabled capability of station
Save RM enabled capability element of an associating station if radio
measurement is supported in its capability field.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-17 12:29:12 +03:00
David Spinadel
2572df34b2 hostapd: Handle Neighbor Report Request frame
Process Neighbor Report Request frame and send Neighbor Report Response
frame based on the configured neighbor report data.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-17 12:29:07 +03:00
David Spinadel
061269b316 hostapd: Add own neighbor report data to neighbor database
Add own neighbor report data to neighbor database based on local LCI and
location civic data.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-16 21:05:40 +03:00
David Spinadel
9b4b226426 hostapd: Add a database of neighboring APs
Add a configurable neighbor database that includes the content of
Nighbor Report element, LCI and Location Civic subelements and SSID.

All parameters for a neighbor must be updated at once; Neighbor Report
element and SSID are mandatory, LCI and civic are optional. The age of
LCI is set to the time of neighbor update.

The control interface API is:
SET_NEIGHBOR <BSSID> <ssid=SSID> <nr=data> [lci=<data>] [civic=<data>]

To delete a neighbor use:
REMOVE_NEIGHBOR <BSSID> <SSID>

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-16 21:05:40 +03:00
David Spinadel
010182120d hostapd: Extend the configuration of RRM capabilities
Extend the radio_measurements parameter to save all the supported
RRM capabilities as it's used in RM enabled capabilities element.

Make this parameter not directly configurable via config file (though,
keep the radio_measurements parameter for some time for backwards
compatibility). Instead, add a configuration option to enable neighbor
report via radio measurements. Other features can be added later as
well.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-16 21:05:39 +03:00
David Spinadel
74e982d8d7 hostapd: Set LCI and Location Civic information in configuration
Enable configuration of LCI and location civic information in
hostapd.conf.

Signed-off-by: David Spinadel <david.spinadel@intel.com>
2016-04-09 11:18:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1854eeca19 Add POLL_STA command to check connectivity in AP mode
The hostapd "POLL_STA <addr>" control interface command can be used to
check whether an associated station ACKs a QoS Data frame. The received
ACK for such a frame is reported as an event message ("AP-STA-POLL-OK
<addr>").

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-04-09 00:30:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3dbfb28cfe Allow AP to disconnect STA without sending Deauth/Disassoc frame
The optional tx=0 parameter can be added to the hostapd
DEAUTHENTICATE/DISASSOCIATE command to request disconnection without
transmitting the Deauthentication/Disassociation frame to the STA.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-04-09 00:30:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
de92314033 Add inactive_msec into STA output
This allows external programs to fetch the driver inactivity value for a
specific STA ("STA <addr>" hostapd control interface command).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-04-09 00:30:49 +03:00
Ayala Beker
ae33239c55 AP: Pass station P2P PS capabilities info during station add/set
If a legacy client with no P2P PS support is trying to connect to
a P2P GO, the driver should know that, and change its PS behavior
accordingly.

Add a parameter to hostapd_sta_add_params() indicating if P2P PS is
supported by the station and pass this parameter to kernel with nl80211
driver when the station is added/set.

Signed-off-by: Ayala Beker <ayala.beker@intel.com>
2016-04-08 13:02:49 +03:00
Ayala Beker
f1863f2b82 RADIUS: Fix possible memory leak when parsing per-STA passphrase
Fix a possible memory leak in decode_tunnel_passwords() if an invalid
passphrase is received from the RADIUS server.

Signed-off-by: Ayala Beker <ayala.beker@intel.com>
2016-04-08 11:19:40 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e1b99620c9 AP: Do not use struct ieee80211_mgmt::u.probe_req
This struct in the union is empty, but the design of using a zero-length
u8 array here is not fully compatible with C++ and can result in
undesired compiler warnings. Since there are no non-IE fields in the
Probe Request frames, get the location of the variable length IEs simply
by using the pointer to the frame header and the known header length.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-04-02 16:55:01 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
795abc8e0a Drop USE_KERNEL_HEADERS define
This was only used for providing an option to use linux/if_packet.h
instgead of netpacket/packet.h in src/ap/iapp.c. However,
netpacket/packet.h is nowadays commonly available and hostapd already
depends on it through src/l2_packet/l2_packet_linux.c, so there is no
need to continue to provide this option for the kernel header.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-26 11:29:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9b7cd5788a Use a separate header file for Linux bridge interface definitions
This moves the BRCTL_* defines from vlan_full.c to linux_bridge.h to
clean up header inclusion.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-26 11:27:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c815fab83a Use own header file for defining Linux VLAN kernel interface
This gets rid of need to include linux/if_vlan.h and additional defines
in vlan_ioctl.c to avoid issues with missing definitions in libc
headers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-26 11:24:38 +02:00
Jörg Krause
81606ab73b vlan: Fix musl libc conflict with Linux kernel headers
Due to both <netinet/in.h> (in "utils/includes.h") and <linux/in6.h> (in
<linux/if_bridge.h>) being included, the in6_addr is being redefined:
once from the C library headers and once from the Linux kernel headers.
This causes some build failures with for example the musl C library:

In file included from /usr/include/linux/if_bridge.h:18,
                 from ../src/ap/vlan_init.c:17:
/usr/include/linux/in6.h:32: error: redefinition of 'struct in6_addr'
/usr/include/linux/in6.h:49: error: redefinition of 'struct sockaddr_in6'
/usr/include/linux/in6.h:59: error: redefinition of 'struct ipv6_mreq'

Mixing C library and Linux kernel headers is a bit problematic [1] and
should be avoided if possible [2]. In order to fix this, define just the
macros needed from <linux/if_bridge.h> as done in Busybox for the brctl
applet [3].

[1] https://sourceware.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=15850
[2] http://www.openwall.com/lists/musl/2015/10/06/1
[3] https://git.busybox.net/busybox/commit/?id=5fa6d1a632505789409a2ba6cf8e112529f9db18

Signed-off-by: Jörg Krause <joerg.krause@embedded.rocks>
2016-03-26 11:02:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e86859929f vlan: Move if_nametoindex() use out of vlan_init.c
With this, vlan_init.c does not need any special header files anymore
and vlan_ifconfig.c does not need hostapd-specific header files that
might conflict with net/if.h on NetBSD.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-25 18:00:44 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7c03c08229 vlan: Move ifconfig helpers to a separate file
This removes final ioctl() use within vlan_init.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-25 17:56:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
59d6390440 vlan: Move CONFIG_FULL_DYNAMIC_VLAN functionality into a separate file
This cleans up vlan_init.c by removing number of C pre-processor
dependencies.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-25 17:55:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0fe28ddf17 vlan: Remove unnecessary header includes from netlink implementation
The implementation in vlan_util.c does not use many of the header files
that were pulled in.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-25 17:27:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
84d6755108 vlan: Clean up netlink vs. ioctl API implementation
Move the ioctl-based VLAN implementation to a separate file to avoid
need for conditional blocks within vlan_ioctl.c. This removes the
internal CONFIG_VLAN_NETLINK define, i.e., this is now used only in
build configuration (.config) to select whether to include the
vlan_util.c (netlink) or vlan_ioctl.c (ioctl) implementation of the
functions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-25 17:24:20 +02:00
Jörg Krause
cb38bc886e vlan: Fix musl build error
caddr_t is legacy BSD and should be avoided [1]. While glibc may still
use __caddr_t as the type, Linux kernel does not (it is "void __user *
ifru_data").

This fixes compile errors with the musl libc:

../src/ap/vlan_init.c: In function 'br_delif':
../src/ap/vlan_init.c:218:18: error: '__caddr_t' undeclared (first use in this function)
  ifr.ifr_data = (__caddr_t) args;

[1] http://stackoverflow.com/questions/6381526/what-is-the-significance-of-caddr-t-and-when-is-it-used

Signed-off-by: Jörg Krause <joerg.krause@embedded.rocks>
2016-03-25 16:57:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8854f90bad mesh: Simplify wpa_auth_pmksa_set_to_sm()
pmksa->pmk or pmksa->pmkid cannot be NULL since they are arrays. Remove
the unnecessary NULL checks and use the provided pmksa pointer directly
to simplify the implementation. (CID 138519)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-03-22 20:38:44 +02:00
Roy Marples
45e3fc72c6 Find correct driver for interface additions/removals
Interface additions/removals are not guaranteed to be for the driver
listening to the kernel events. As such, send the events to
wpa_supplicant_event_global() which can then pick the correct interface
registered with wpa_supplicant to send the event to.

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-03-22 17:41:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
90377029c6 wpa_supplicant: Fix CONFIG_IBSS_RSN=y build without CONFIG_AP=y
Commit 1889af2e0f ('VLAN: Separate station
grouping and uplink configuration') added an ap_sta_set_vlan() function
that gets called from pmksa_cache_auth.c. This broke CONFIG_IBSS_RSN=y
build if src/ap/sta_info.c did not get included in the build, i.e., if
CONFIG_AP=y was not set.

Fix this by making the ap_sta_set_vlan() call conditional on
CONFIG_NO_VLAN being undefined and define this for CONFIG_IBSS_RSN=y
builds. This is fine for wpa_supplicant since CONFIG_AP=y case was
already defining this. For hostapd, this function call is not needed for
CONFIG_NO_VLAN case either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-21 21:12:20 +02:00
Masashi Honma
9f2cf23e2e mesh: Add support for PMKSA caching
This patch add functionality of mesh SAE PMKSA caching. If the local STA
already has peer's PMKSA entry in the cache, skip SAE authentication and
start AMPE with the cached value.

If the peer does not support PMKSA caching or does not have the local
STA's PMKSA entry in the cache, AMPE will fail and the PMKSA cache entry
of the peer will be removed. Then STA retries with ordinary SAE
authentication.

If the peer does not support PMKSA caching and the local STA uses
no_auto_peer=1, the local STA can not retry SAE authentication because
NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE event cannot start SAE authentication when
no_auto_peer=1. So this patch extends MESH_PEER_ADD command to use
duration(sec). Throughout the duration, the local STA can start SAE
authentication triggered by NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE even though
no_auto_peer=1.

This commit requires commit 70c93963ed
('SAE: Fix PMKID calculation for PMKSA cache'). Without that commit,
chosen PMK comparison will fail.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-03-20 17:56:38 +02:00
Masashi Honma
4c522c7798 PMKSA: Flush AP/mesh PMKSA cache by PMKSA_FLUSH command
This extends the wpa_supplicant PMKSA_FLUSH control interface command to
allow the PMKSA list from the authenticator side to be flushed for AP
and mesh mode. In addition, this adds a hostapd PMKSA_FLUSH control
interface command to flush the PMKSA entries.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-03-20 17:37:53 +02:00
Masashi Honma
b8daac18a4 PMKSA: Show AP/mesh PMKSA list in PMKSA command
This extends the wpa_supplicant PMKSA control interface command to allow
the PMKSA list from the authenticator side to be listed for AP and mesh
mode. In addition, this adds a hostapd PMKSA control interface command
to show the same list for the AP case.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-03-20 17:37:53 +02:00
Zefir Kurtisi
3bd58861ae hostapd: Handle running out of DFS channels
In scenarios where only DFS channels are available (e.g., outdoor,
special country codes), hostapd must be able to handle situations
where all are unavailable.

The two possibilities to get there are
1) while operating on the last available DFS channel a radar is
   detected
2) hostapd is started while all channels are unavailable

In both cases, hostapd instead of terminating should better
wait for the NOPs to pass and re-try operation after the CAC.

This patch provides that feature by using the condition
(iface->state == HAPD_IFACE_DFS && !iface->cac_started)
as NOP mode signature to retry operation from within
hostapd_dfs_nop_finished().

Signed-off-by: Zefir Kurtisi <zefir.kurtisi@neratec.com>
2016-03-08 12:16:37 +02:00
Eliad Peller
6448e06415 hostapd: Allow use of driver-generated interface addresses
Add a new 'use_driver_iface_addr' configuration parameter to allow use
of the default interface address generated by the driver on interface
creation. This can be useful when specific MAC addresses were allocated
to the device and we want to use them for multi-BSS operation.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2016-03-06 20:00:40 +02:00
Eliad Peller
f2accfe708 AP: Save EAPOL received before Association Response ACK
There is a race condition in which AP might receive the EAPOL-Start
frame (from the just-associated station) before the TX completion of the
Association Response frame. This in turn will cause the EAPOL-Start
frame to get dropped, and potentially failing the connection.

Solve this by saving EAPOL frames from authenticated-but-not-associated
stations, and handling them during the Association Response frame TX
completion processing.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2016-03-06 17:08:12 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
56885eecf4 hostapd: Add UDP support for ctrl_iface
Add UDP support for ctrl_iface:

New config option could be set:
CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE=udp
CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE=udp-remote
CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE=udp6
CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE=udp6-remote

And hostapd_cli usage:
hostapd_cli -i localhost:8877

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 17:44:37 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
89b781bc89 hostapd: Use common functions for ctrl_iface
Use the common functions, structures when UNIX socket ctrl_iface used.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2016-03-05 17:15:05 +02:00
Peng Xu
e1d00d47c7 Add error handling for offloaded ACS with vendor command failures
In case vendor ACS command returns invalid channel or hardware mode,
complete the interface setup with an error code instead of simply
return, so that hostapd can properly clean up the interface setup.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-03-03 12:19:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
debde14b5b RADIUS: Add Acct-Delay-Time into accounting messages
This tells to the server how long we have been trying to transmit the
message so that the actual time of the message generation can be
determined from receive time (ignoring network delays and only at
accuracy of one second).

For interim updates, only value 0 is used since there are no
retransmissions of the same message. For other accounting messages, the
initial attempt goes out with value 0 and the retransmissions, if
needed, show the number of seconds the message has been waiting in the
queue.

Update the Identifier and Authenticator in the messages whenever
updating the Acct-Delay-Time per RFC 2866, 4.1 requirements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-29 17:43:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
669b5324e1 RADIUS: Update full message for interim accounting updates
Instead of using the RADIUS client retransmission design with the old
RADIUS message contents for each retry, trigger a completely new interim
accounting update instance more quickly (using the same schedule as
RADIUS message retransmissions) to improve accounting updates in cases
where RADIUS message delivery fails. This allows the server to get up to
date information from the time the "retry" message was sent instead of
the old information from the time the first failed attempt was sent.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-29 11:52:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
902c07a7af Replace hostapd_mac_comp_empty() with is_zero_ether_addr()
There is no need to maintain two implementations of the functionality.
is_zero_ether_addr() is easier to understand, so use it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-28 20:11:58 +02:00
Michael Braun
5aef495fda VLAN: Avoid use of libnl cache
Using rtnl_link_alloc_cache() is expensive as it fills in all configured
links. Using rtnl_link_get_kernel() is much more lightweight.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 20:05:17 +02:00
Michael Braun
170c545ab4 FT: Check destination MAC address on RRB receive
As the Linux variant of l2_packet_init() does not use its own_addr
argument and l2_packet_receive() does not filter on destination MAC
address, this needs to be checked in the callback.

If there are multiple BSSes listening for FT RRB packets, all their
BSSIDs need to be local to the bridge interface. As l2_packet_init() is
going to receive all of them going for any local address, those RRB
messages started turning up on BSSes that were not destinated for and
cluttering logs.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 19:23:17 +02:00
Michael Braun
57b2c9140c RADIUS: Allow RADIUS server to provide PSK instead of passphrase
If the AP is slow, passphrase hashing takes too long to serve the client
before timeout. Extend the Tunnel-Password design to allow a 64
character value to be interpreted as a PSK and send SSID to RADIUS
server. This allows the RADIUS server to either take care of passphrase
hashing or to use raw PSK without such hashing.

This is especially important for FT-PSK with FT-over-air, where hashing
cannot be deferred.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 19:06:49 +02:00
Michael Braun
d8912fd80e Cache hashed passphrase in RADIUS-based PSK delivery
Instead of copying the full struct hostapd_sta_wpa_psk_short, share the
existing entry and use reference counting to check when it needs to be
freed. This allows caching of PSKs derived from passphrases to avoid
having to perform the heavy hashing operation multiple times.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 19:06:45 +02:00
Michael Braun
f8e09bc57e Defer passphrase-to-PSK hashing out of 802.11 authentication ACL check
Hashing takes quite some time (can be about one second on a low-power
CPU for each passphrase provided), so hostapd can easily hit the 900 ms
Wi-Fi client authentication deadline (mac80211 uses 3x 300 ms). This can
be fixed by storing the passphrase instead of PSK with the STA and defer
the hashing into the WPA/RSN 4-way handshake, when enumerating all PSKs.

This applies for the case where a RADIUS server is used to store the
per-STA passphrases and this passphrase is delivered as part of the MAC
ACL check during IEEE 802.11 Authentication frame processing.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 18:46:05 +02:00
Michael Braun
cc9c805a51 VLAN: Use stack instead of heap allocation for new interface name
The VLAN ifname is limited to the maximum length of IFNAMSIZ, so there
is no need to use heap allocation for it.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 18:29:58 +02:00
Michael Braun
d48d1b88d0 FT: Use BSSID as r1_key_holder if no value is configured
r1_key_holder is an identifier that was always set to zero if unless
configured before.

See 11.6.1.7.4 of IEEE Std 802.11-2012 which reads
 "R1KH-ID is a MAC address of the holder of the PMK-R1 in the
  Authenticator of the AP"
See 12.2.2 of IEEE Std 802.11-2012 which reads
 "Each R0KH-ID and R1KH-ID is assumed to be expressed as a unique
  identifier within the mobility domain."
 "The R1KH-ID shall be set to a MAC address of the physical entity
  that stores the PMK-R1 ..."

Defaulting this to BSSID is a more reasonable value since we have not
rejected the missing r1_key_holder as invalid configuration.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 17:56:42 +02:00
Michael Braun
71456dbdf2 FT: Check hapd->wpa_auth before RRB internal delivery
A malicious station could try to do FT-over-DS with a non WPA-enabled
BSS. When this BSS is located in the same hostapd instance, internal RRB
delivery will be used and thus the FT Action Frame will be processed by
a non-WPA enabled BSS. This processing used to crash hostapd as
hapd->wpa_auth is NULL. If the target BSS is on a different hostapd
instance, it will not listen for these packets and thus not crash.

Fix this by checking hapd->wpa_auth before delivery.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 17:45:45 +02:00
Michael Braun
0270bdedcc FT: Fix R0KH-R1KH protocol data length values
The FT RRB hostapd packets have a length field. For PULL frames, it
counted the bytes starting with nonce and up to the last before pad. For
RESP frames, it counted the bytes starting with nonce and up to the last
before pad except for 2 bytes. For PUSH frames, it counted the bytes
starting with nonce and up to including pad.

As rounding is done with AES encryption, including pad does not make
sense. Not including the last field before pad does not make sense
either. These were broken in the earlier addition of the 2 octet
pairwise field in commit 1b484d60e5 ('FT:
Include pairwise cipher suite in PMK-R0 SA and PMK-R1 SA').

AES encryption is not affected, as rounding hides the differences. The
packets data_length field is not used, so the differences have no effect
there.

This patch changes the constants to match the bytes used, thus excluding
the pad. To validate the changes, look at remainder modulo 8 of the sum
of the size constants and the padding sizes.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-28 15:43:50 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
adf0478e8e AP: Store STA supported operating classes information
This makes hostapd track Supported Operating Classes information from
the associated STAs. The stored information is available through the STA
control interface command (supp_op_classes row) as a hexdump of the
Supported Operating Classes element starting from the Length field. This
information can be used as input to BSS transition management and
channel switching decisions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-24 12:20:31 +02:00
Dedy Lansky
077dcfb8c4 AP: Debug print management frame TX result
Inside management frame TX status callback, print the TX result where it
was missing. This is useful for debugging management frame drops.

Signed-off-by: Dedy Lansky <qca_dlansky@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 21:51:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ca911d61f3 MBO: Parse non-preferred channel list on the AP
This adds parsing of non-preferred channel list on an MBO AP. The
information in (Re)Association Request and WNM Notification Request
frames is parsed to get the initial value and updates from each
associated MBO STA. The parsed information is available through the STA
control interface command non_pref_chan[i] rows.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 21:17:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3f48274d0e WNM: Fix a memory leak on AP error path
If the second memory allocation in ieee802_11_send_wnmsleep_resp() were
to fail and ieee80211_11_get_tfs_ie() succeed, the wnmtfs_ie allocation
would not have been freed on the error path.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Michael Braun
f5ca1766dc VLAN: Fix vlan_compare() for tagged VLANs
While refactoring VLAN comparison into vlan_compare(), it was overlooked
that modifications are needed for tagged VLAN support.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4c572281ed MBO: Mandate use of PMF for WPA2+MBO association (AP)
If WPA2 and MBO are enabled, PMF needs to be enabled in hostapd
configuration. If PMF is optional in the configuration, an MBO STA is
required to negotiate use of PMF.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8dd49f0cff MBO: Update STA cellular data capability based on WNM Notification
This makes hostapd parse a received WNM Notification Request frame
subelements and if a WFA MBO cellular data capability subelement is
seen, update the cellular data capability for the STA.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6332aaf3b2 MBO: Track STA cellular data capability from association request
This makes hostapd parse the MBO attribute in (Re)Association Request
frame and track the cellular data capability (mbo_cell_capa=<val> in STA
control interface command).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f3cb7a6969 WNM: Minimal processing for WNM Notification Request frames on AP
Write debug log entries on receiving WNM Notification Request frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e578343457 MBO: Indicate WNM-Notification support on AP when MBO is enabled
This is needed to allow MBO STAs to send WNM Notification Request
frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
990b7b6f38 Simplify hostapd_build_ap_extra_ies() with helper functions
This removes multiple copies of wpabuf_resize() following by
wpabuf_put_{buf,data}() with the help of two simple helper functions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
c0e2a172a7 hostapd: Add MBO IE to BSS Transition Management Request frame
Add an option to add MBO IE to BSS Transition Management Request frame.
The MBO IE includes the transition reason code, cellular data connection
preference, and, if the disassoc imminent bit is set, it may also
include re-association retry delay. Otherwise, the re-association retry
delay should be set to zero.

The additional BSS_TM_REQ argument uses the following format:
mbo=<reason>:<reassoc delay>:<cell pref>
reason: 0-9
reassoc delay: 0-65535 (seconds; 0 = disabled)
cell pref: 0, 1, 255

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Avraham Stern
fb9a1c3e28 hostapd: Add MBO IE to Beacon, Probe Response, Association Response
Add MBO IE with AP capability attribute to Beacon, Probe Response, and
(Re)Association Response frames to indicate the AP supports MBO.

Add option to add Association Disallowed attribute to Beacon, Probe
Response, and (Re)Association Response frames. Usage:

SET mbo_assoc_disallow <reason code>

Valid reason code values are between 1-5. Setting the reason code to
0 will remove the Association Disallowed attribute from the MBO IE
and will allow new associations.

MBO functionality is enabled by setting "mbo=1" in the config file.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2016-02-22 19:53:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
75cc211d6b VLAN: Check vlan_desc validity in a failure debug print
The recent VLAN changes added an explicit code path that sets vlan_desc
= NULL within ap_sta_set_vlan(). This makes some code analyzers warn
about the debug print that could potentially dereference this pointer.
Silence that warning by verifying the pointer more consistently within
this function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-20 19:22:43 +02:00
Nick Lowe
43022abdb9 Use 64-bit TX/RX byte counters for statistics
If the driver supports 64-bit TX/RX byte counters, use them directly.
The old 32-bit counter extension is maintained for backwards
compatibility with older drivers.

For nl80211 driver interface, the newer NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64 and
NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64 attributes are used when available. This
resolves the race vulnerable 32-bit value wrap/overflow. Rework RADIUS
accounting to use these for Acct-Input-Octets, Acct-Input-Gigawords,
Acct-Output-Octets, and Acct-Output-Gigawords, these values are often
used for billing purposes.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-20 19:03:10 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
3f81ac0762 AP: Set STA assoc flag in the driver before sending Assoc Resp frame
Previously, stations were added to the driver only after the
(Re)Association Response frame was acked. In the time period between the
station has acked the (Re)Association Response frame and the time the
station was added to the kernel, the station can already start sending
Data frames, which will be dropped by the hardware/driver. In addition
to the data loss, the driver may ignore NDPs with PM bit set from this
STA.

Fix this by setting/adding the STA with associated flag set to the
driver before the AP sends the (Re)Association Response frame with
status success. If the (Re)Association Response frame wasn't acked,
remove the station from the driver.

Note that setting a station to associated state before the non-AP
station acknowledges the (Re)Association Response frame is not compliant
with the IEEE 802.11 standard that specifically states that a non-AP
station should transition to authenticated/associated state only after
it acknowledged the (Re)Association Response frame. However, this is a
justifiable simplification to work around the issue described above since

1. The station will be removed in case it does not acknowledge the
   (Re)Association Response frame.
2. All Data frames would be dropped until the station is set to
   authorized state and there are no known issues with processing the
   other Class 3 frames during the short window before the
   acknowledgement is seen.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2016-02-20 18:25:13 +02:00
Ayala Beker
bb598c3bdd AP: Add support for full station state
Add support for drivers that support full AP client state, i.e., can
handle adding stations that are not associated yet. For such drivers,
add a station after processing the authentication request, instead of
adding it in the association response callback.

Doing so is beneficial in cases where the driver cannot handle the add
station request, in which case it is useless to perform the complete
connection establishment.

Signed-off-by: Ayala Beker <ayala.beker@intel.com>
2016-02-20 18:25:13 +02:00
Nick Lowe
239952b4da DFS: Remove the os_random() fallback
Remove the fallback dependency on os_random() from the code that gets a
valid DFS channel. This is exceptionally unlikely to ever be called as
the call to os_get_random() is unlikely to fail. The intention is to
facilitate future removal of os_random() as it uses a low quality PRNG.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:40 +02:00
Nick Lowe
98a516eae8 WPS: Use only os_get_random() for PIN generation
Remove the fallback dependency on os_random() when generating a WPS pin.
This is exceptionally unlikely to ever be called as the call to
os_get_random() is unlikely to fail. The intention is to facilitate
future removal of os_random() as it uses a low quality PRNG.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:40 +02:00
Nick Lowe
f441e5af77 Use os_get_random() for Shared Key authentication challenge
Do not use the system clock or os_random() that uses a low quality PRNG
as part of the pseudo-random challenge in auth_shared_key(). The
construction can be improved upon by replacing it with a call to
os_get_random(), which uses a high quality PRNG.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:40 +02:00
Nick Lowe
8c676b5056 Add RADIUS Service-Type attribute with a value of Framed
This seems to be the common value used by APs and also mentioned in RFC
3580.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-19 18:44:39 +02:00
Masashi Honma
09d96de09e mesh: Drop Authentication frames from BLOCKED STA
Previously, only mesh Action frames from BLOCKED STA were dropped.
Extend that to drop Authentication frames as well.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-02-18 21:27:06 +02:00
Masashi Honma
70c93963ed SAE: Fix PMKID calculation for PMKSA cache
The SAE PMKID is calculated with IEEE Std 802.11-2012 11.3.5.4, but the
PMKID was re-calculated with 11.6.1.3 and saved into PMKSA cache. Fix
this to save the PMKID calculated with 11.3.5.4 into the PMKSA cache.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2016-02-18 21:07:47 +02:00
Nick Lowe
1492fbb90c Print Acct-Session-Id and Acct-Multi-Session-Id 64-bit values
These are now 64-bit variables and the printf formats and type casts
need to be updated to match.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-18 20:58:21 +02:00
Roy Marples
a5a3efccc2 Fix compile on NetBSD for vlan
Shuffle includes above system ones so to fix a compile issue
on NetBSD where the if_type #define from <net/if.h>
conflicts with the wpa_driver_if_type enum.

Signed-off-by: Roy Marples <roy@marples.name>
2016-02-18 17:09:14 +02:00
Michael Braun
8be640b780 VLAN: Add per-STA vif option
This allows the stations to be assigned to their own vif. It does not
need dynamic_vlan to be set. Make hostapd call ap_sta_set_vlan even if
!vlan_desc.notempty, so vlan_id can be assigned regardless.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:13 +02:00
Michael Braun
d0bdc96bdd VLAN: Actually add tagged VLANs to AP_VLAN
This makes vlan_newlink() and vlan_dellink() add tagged VLANs to AP_VLAN
interfaces as given by struct vlan_description.

hostapd_vlan_if_remove() is done in vlan_dellink() as tagged interfaces
need to be removed before the interface can be deleted and a DELLINK
message can be generated.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:13 +02:00
Michael Braun
f9c00188ca VLAN: Factor out per-vid code in newlink/dellink
To prepare for adding tagged VLAN support in vlan_init.c, vlan_newlink()
and vlan_dellink() are split into multiple functions. This reduces
indention and eases adding tagged VLANs as well.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:13 +02:00
Michael Braun
8e44c192da radius: Add tagged VLAN parsing
1. Add tagged VLAN to struct vlan_description
    (compile limited number of tagged VLANs per description)
    For k tagged VLANs, the first k entries in vlan_description.tagged
    are used. They are sorted in ascending order. All other entries are
    zero. This way os_memcmp() can find identical configurations.
2. Let tagged VLANs be parsed from RADIUS Access-Accept
3. Print VLAN %d+ with %d=untagged VID if tagged VLANs are set
4. Select an unused vlan_id > 4096 for new tagged VLAN configurations
5. Add EGRESS_VLAN RADIUS attribute parsing also for untagged VLANs

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:13 +02:00
Michael Braun
1889af2e0f VLAN: Separate station grouping and uplink configuration
Separate uplink configuration (IEEE 802.1q VID) and grouping of stations
into AP_VLAN interfaces.

The int vlan_id will continue to identify the AP_VLAN interface the
station should be assigned to. Each AP_VLAN interface corresponds to an
instance of struct hostapd_vlan that is uniquely identified by int
vlan_id within an BSS.

New: Each station and struct hostapd_vlan holds a struct
vlan_description vlan_desc member that describes the uplink
configuration requested. Currently this is just an int untagged IEEE
802.1q VID, but can be extended to tagged VLANs and other settings
easily.

When the station was about to be assigned its vlan_id, vlan_desc and
vlan_id will now be set simultaneously by ap_sta_set_vlan(). So
sta->vlan_id can still be tested for whether the station needs to be
moved to an AP_VLAN interface.

To ease addition of tagged VLAN support, a member notempty is added to
struct vlan_description. Is is set to 1 if an untagged or tagged VLAN
assignment is requested and needs to be validated. The inverted form
allows os_zalloc() to initialize an empty description.

Though not depended on by the code, vlan_id assignment ensures:
  * vlan_id = 0 will continue to mean no AP_VLAN interface
  * vlan_id < 4096 will continue to mean vlan_id = untagged vlan id
    with no per_sta_vif and no extra tagged vlan.
  * vlan_id > 4096 will be used for per_sta_vif and/or tagged vlans.

This way struct wpa_group and drivers API do not need to be changed in
order to implement tagged VLANs or per_sta_vif support.

DYNAMIC_VLAN_* will refer to (struct vlan_description).notempty only,
thus grouping of the stations for per_sta_vif can be used with
DYNAMIC_VLAN_DISABLED, but not with CONFIG_NO_VLAN, as struct
hostapd_vlan is still used to manage AP_VLAN interfaces.

MAX_VLAN_ID will be checked in hostapd_vlan_valid and during setup of
VLAN interfaces and refer to IEEE 802.1q VID. VLAN_ID_WILDCARD will
continue to refer to int vlan_id.

Renaming vlan_id to vlan_desc when type changed from int to struct
vlan_description was avoided when vlan_id was also used in a way that
did not depend on its type (for example, when passed to another
function).

Output of "VLAN ID %d" continues to refer to int vlan_id, while "VLAN
%d" will refer to untagged IEEE 802.1q VID.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2016-02-17 11:46:11 +02:00
Lior David
b907491281 wpa_supplicant: Basic support for PBSS/PCP
PBSS (Personal Basic Service Set) is a new BSS type for DMG
networks. It is similar to infrastructure BSS, having an AP-like
entity called PCP (PBSS Control Point), but it has few differences.
PBSS support is mandatory for IEEE 802.11ad devices.

Add a new "pbss" argument to network block. The argument is used
in the following scenarios:
1. When network has mode=2 (AP), when pbss flag is set will start
as a PCP instead of an AP.
2. When network has mode=0 (station), when pbss flag is set will
connect to PCP instead of AP.

The function wpa_scan_res_match() was modified to match BSS according to
the pbss flag in the network block (wpa_ssid structure). When pbss flag
is set it will match only PCPs, and when it is clear it will match only
APs.

Signed-off-by: Lior David <qca_liord@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-08 22:23:56 +02:00
Srinivasa Duvvuri
9684c7567e mesh: Fix peer link counting when a mesh peer reconnects
When a mesh point reconnects by starting from Authentication frame
sequence, the plink count was not decremented from its last connection.
This resulted in leaking peer link count and causing wpa_supplicant to
reject the connection after max_peer_links (default: 99) reconnects.

This was reproduced by pre-configuring 2 mesh points with mesh
credentials. Boot both mesh points and make sure they connect to each
other. Then in a loop reboot one of the mesh points after it
successfully connects while leaving the other mesh point up and running.
After 99 iterations the supplicant on mesh point that is not rebooting
will reject the connection request from the other mesh point.

Fix this by decrementing num_plinks when freeing a STA entry that is
still in PLINK_ESTAB state.

Signed-off-by: Srinivasa Duvvuri <sduvvuri@chromium.org>
2016-02-06 21:22:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1fc63fe299 RADIUS: Share a single function for generating session IDs
There is no need to maintain three copies of this functionality even if
it is currently implemented as a single function call.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-06 17:19:35 +02:00
Nick Lowe
2cbc6ffb3a RADIUS: Redesign Request Authenticator generation
Simplify and make properly random the generation of the Request
Authenticator.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 17:19:35 +02:00
Nick Lowe
b71a64aa01 Send an Acct-Multi-Session-Id attribute in Access-Request packets
Previously, this was included only in Accounting-Request packets.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 17:13:21 +02:00
Nick Lowe
4260e1a1ff Add Acct-Session-Id to Accounting-On/Off
An Acct-Session-Id is required on Accounting-On and Accounting-Off forms
of Accounting-Request.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 17:11:01 +02:00
Nick Lowe
d72a00539c RADIUS: Use more likely unique accounting Acct-{,Multi-}Session-Id
Rework the Acct-Session-Id and Acct-Multi-Session-Id implementation to
give better global and temporal uniqueness. Previously, only 32-bits of
the Acct-Session-Id would contain random data, the other 32-bits would
be incremented. Previously, the Acct-Multi-Session-Id would not use
random data. Switch from two u32 variables to a single u64 for the
Acct-Session-Id and Acct-Multi-Session-Id. Do not increment, this serves
no legitimate purpose. Exclusively use os_get_random() to get quality
random numbers, do not use or mix in the time. Inherently take a
dependency on /dev/urandom working properly therefore. Remove the global
Acct-Session-Id and Acct-Multi-Session-Id values that serve no
legitimate purpose.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 17:10:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d689317ddb EAPOL auth: Move radius_cui/identity freeing to eapol_auth_free()
These can get allocated within eapol_auth_alloc(), so it is more logical
to free them in eapol_auth_free() instead of ieee802_1x_free_station()
that ends up calling eapol_auth_free().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-02-06 16:32:22 +02:00
Nick Lowe
9b6177a891 Add Event-Timestamp to all Accounting-Request packets
Event-Timestamp should be sent for all Accounting-Request packets and
only after the system clock has a sane value, not where there's a value
close to the Unix time epoch.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-06 01:24:59 +02:00
Max Stepanov
d179089b6d GAS: Calculate response buffer length of ANQP elements
Calculate the required length needed for the extra ANQP elements added
to GAS response buffer instead of using fixed size and truncating the
response if there was not sufficient space.

Signed-off-by: Max Stepanov <Max.Stepanov@intel.com>
2016-02-06 01:19:32 +02:00
Nick Lowe
479f46c4c2 Do not send Acct-Authentic in Accounting-On/Off
Acct-Authentic is used to indicate how the user was authenticated and as
such, should not be sent in Accounting-On and Accounting-Off.

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-05 18:06:33 +02:00
Nick Lowe
696544efed RADIUS: Do not include Acct-Terminate-Cause in Accounting-On/Off
Per RFC 2866, 5.10, it is invalid to send Acct-Terminate-Cause in
Accounting-On and Accounting-Off (this is included only when
Acct-Status-Type is set to Stop).

Signed-off-by: Nick Lowe <nick.lowe@lugatech.com>
2016-02-05 17:59:07 +02:00
Eduardo Abinader
236053e532 Make fallback from HT40 to HT20 work
Ensure that if it is not possible to configure an allowed 20 MHz
channel pair, hostapd falls back to a single 20 MHz channel.

Signed-off-by: Eduardo Abinader <eabinader@ocedo.com>
2016-02-05 17:52:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
03a72eacda VHT: Add an interoperability workaround for 80+80 and 160 MHz channels
Number of deployed 80 MHz capable VHT stations that do not support 80+80
and 160 MHz bandwidths seem to misbehave when trying to connect to an AP
that advertises 80+80 or 160 MHz channel bandwidth in the VHT Operation
element. To avoid such issues with deployed devices, modify the design
based on newly proposed IEEE 802.11 standard changes.

This allows poorly implemented VHT 80 MHz stations to connect with the
AP in 80 MHz mode. 80+80 and 160 MHz capable stations need to support
the new workaround mechanism to allow full bandwidth to be used.
However, there are more or less no impacted station with 80+80/160
capability deployed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-02-02 00:09:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
03269d558a AP: Print interface name in more STA events
This makes it easier to follow a debug log from a hostapd process that
manages multiple interfaces.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-15 19:32:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9e8fde2134 AP: Fix Deauth/Disassoc TX status timeout handling
The ap_sta_deauth_cb and ap_sta_disassoc_cb eloop timeouts are used to
clear a disconnecting STA from the kernel driver if the STA did not ACK
the Deauthentication/Disassociation frame from the AP within two
seconds. However, it was possible for a STA to not ACK such a frame,
e.g., when the disconnection happened due to hostapd pruning old
associations from other BSSes and the STA was not on the old channel
anymore. If that same STA then started a new authentication/association
with the BSS, the two second timeout could trigger during this new
association and result in the STA entry getting removed from the kernel.

Fix this by canceling these eloop timeouts when receiving an indication
of a new authentication or association.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-15 19:32:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
12a81b64e1 ACS: Remove unreachable case from a debug print
n_chans can have only values 1, 2, or 4 in this function, so the -1 case
could never be reached. Remove the unreachable case to get rid of static
analyzer warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-07 16:50:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
896607d36b Remove a pointer check that can never be true
chan is set to the result of pointer arithmetic (pointer to an entry in
an array) that can never be NULL. As such, there is no need to check for
it to be non-NULL before deference. Remove this check to avoid
complaints from static analyzers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-07 16:47:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a95cc47a92 ACS: Be more consistent with iface->current_mode checks
Offloading of ACS to the driver changed the design a bit in a way that
iface->current_mode could actually be NULL when the offloaded ACS
mechanism supports band selection in addition to channel selection. This
resulted in a combination that is too complex for static analyzers to
notice. While acs_init() can be called with iface->current_mode == NULL
that is only in the case where WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_ACS_OFFLOAD is in use.
In other words, the actual ACS functions like acs_cleanup() that would
dereference iface->current_mode are not used in such a case.

Get rid of static analyzer warnings by explicitly checking
iface->current_mode in acs_init() for the case where ACS offloading is
not used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2016-01-07 16:39:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4f6cd3f426 Fix wpa_supplicant AP mode P2P IE handling if P2P is disabled
If P2P support is included in wpa_supplicant build (CONFIG_P2P=y), but
P2P functionality is explicitly disabled (e.g., "P2P_SET disabled 1"),
couple of AP management frame processing steps did not check against
hapd->p2p_group being NULL and could end up dereferencing a NULL pointer
if a Probe Request frame or (Re)Association Request frame was received
with a P2P IE in it. Fix this by skipping these steps if hapd->p2p_group
is NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-01 17:12:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db671e0aee WPS: Do not build Credential with unsupported encr combination on AP
It was possible for the Registrar code to generate a Credential with
auth type WPAPSK (i.e., WPA v1) with encr type AES if the Enrollee
claimed support for WPAPSK and not WPA2PSK while the AP was configured
in mixed mode WPAPSK+WPA2PSK regardless of how wpa_pairwise (vs.
rsn_pairwise) was set since encr type was selected from the union of
wpa_pairwise and rsn_pairwise. This could result in the Enrollee
receiving a Credential that it could then not use with the AP.

Fix this by masking the encryption types separately on AP based on the
wpa_pairwise/rsn_pairwise configuration. In the example case described
above, the Credential would get auth=WPAPSK encr=TKIP instead of
auth=WPAPSK encr=AES.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2016-01-01 13:42:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d7c3347f59 HS 2.0: Postpone WNM-Notification sending by 100 ms
This makes it somewhat easier for the station to be able to receive and
process the encrypted WNM-Notification frames that the AP previously
sentt immediately after receiving EAPOL-Key msg 4/4. While the station
is supposed to have the TK configured for receive before sending out
EAPOL-Key msg 4/4, not many actual implementations do that. As such,
there is a race condition in being able to configure the key at the
station and the AP sending out the first encrypted frame after EAPOL-Key
4/4. The extra 100 ms time here makes it more likely for the station to
have managed to configure the key in time.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-31 21:46:08 +02:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
d99097177a wpa_supplicant: Enable Automatic Channel Selection support for AP mode
Since hostapd supports ACS now, let's enable its support in
wpa_supplicant as well when starting AP mode.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: rebased series from hostap_2_1~944 to master]
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: adjusted added text in defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Ulrich Ölmann <u.oelmann@pengutronix.de>
2015-12-24 22:24:05 +02:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
96bc508684 Handle survey event properly in wpa_supplicant
Let's reuse hostapd code for such handling. This will be useful to get
ACS support into wpa_supplicant where this one needs to handle the
survey event so it fills in the result ACS subsystem will require.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
[u.oelmann@pengutronix.de: rebased series from hostap_2_1~944 to master]
Signed-off-by: Ulrich Ölmann <u.oelmann@pengutronix.de>
2015-12-24 21:35:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5bd9be4d17 Fix RADIUS Called-Station-Id to not escape SSID
Commit 986de33d5c ('Convert remaining SSID
routines from char* to u8*') started using wpa_ssid_txt() to print out
the SSID for the Called-Station-Id attribute in RADIUS messages. This
was further modified by commit 6bc1f95613
('Use printf escaping in SSID-to-printable-string conversion') to use
printf escaping (though, even without this, wpa_ssid_txt() would have
masked characters).

This is not desired for Called-Station-Id attribute. While it is defined
as a "String", RFC 2865 indicates that "a robust implementation SHOULD
support the field as undistinguished octets.".

Copy the SSID as an array of arbitrary octets into Called-Station-Id to
avoid any kind of masking or escaping behavior. This goes a step further
from the initial implementation by allowing even the possible (but
unlikely in practical use cases) 0x00 octet in the middle of an SSID.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-24 12:15:36 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5addb0df59 Server configuration for OCSP stapling with ocsp_multi (RFC 6961)
This adds a new hostapd configuration parameter
ocsp_stapling_response_multi that can be used similarly to the existing
ocsp_stapling_response, but for the purpose of providing multiple cached
OCSP responses. This commit adds only the configuration parameter, but
does not yet add support for this mechanism with any of the supported
TLS implementations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-22 19:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a587666cba GAS server: Replenish temporary STA entry timeout on comeback request
Previously, the five second timeout was added at the beginning of the
full GAS query and it was not replenished during fragmented exchanges.
This could result in timing out a query if it takes significant time to
go through the possibly multiple fragments and long comeback delay.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-12-20 19:43:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9257610a6e FT: Fix FTIE generation for EAPOL-Key msg 3/4
This FTIE needs to be an exact copy of the one in (Re)Association
Response frame. Copy the stored element rather than building a new copy
that would not have the correct MIC value. This is needed to fix PTK
rekeying after FT protocol run.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-10 00:14:36 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e44bd28cd1 FT: Fix sm->assoc_resp_ftie storing on the AP side
The FTIE from (Re)Association Response frame was copied before
calculating the MIC. This resulted in incorrect value being used when
comparing the EAPOL-Key msg 2/4 value in case PTK rekeying was used
after FT protocol run. Fix this by storing the element after the MIC
field has been filled in.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-10 00:14:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
59e78c2408 FT: Fix FTIE generation for 4-way handshake after FT protocol run
wpa_insert_pmkid() did not support cases where the original RSN IE
included any PMKIDs. That case can happen when PTK rekeying through
4-way handshake is used after FT protocol run. Such a 4-way handshake
used to fail with wpa_supplicant being unable to build the EAPOL-Key msg
2/4.

Fix this by extending wpa_insert_pmkid() to support removal of the old
PMKIDs, if needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-12-10 00:14:35 +02:00
Rajkumar Manoharan
3c417499e7 hostapd: Add Transmit Power Envelope IE when VHT is enabled
Add Transmit Power Envelope element defined in IEEE P802.11-REVmc/D4.3,
8.4.2.161.

Signed-off-by: Rajkumar Manoharan <rmanohar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-26 20:40:24 +02:00
Avraham Stern
d8a3b66d7f driver: Make setting up AP optional when creating AP interface
When an AP interface it created, it is also setup and subscribes
for management frames etc. However, when the interface is added by
wpa_supplicant, setting up for AP operations is redundant because
it will be done by wpa_supplicant on wpa_drv_init() when setting
the interface mode to AP.

In addition, it may cause wpa_supplicant to fail initializing the
interface as it will try to subscribe for management frames on this
interface but the interface is already registered.

Change this, so when adding an AP interface, make setting up the AP
optional, and use it only when the interface is added by hostapd but not
when it is added by wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-11-22 17:42:59 +02:00
Alexander Bondar
6bdc43c4db AP: Avoid 20/40 MHz co-ex scan if PRI/SEC switch is not allowed
When an AP is started on the 5.2 GHz band with 40 MHz bandwidth, a
scan is issued in order to handle 20/40 MHz coexistence. However,
the scan is issued even if iface->conf->no_pri_sec_switch is set,
which is redundant.

Fix this by checking iface->conf->no_pri_sec_switch before starting
the scan.

Signed-off-by: Alexander Bondar <alexander.bondar@intel.com>
2015-11-21 18:42:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f68d491b0a FT auth: Fix EAPOL reauthentication after FT protocol run
The EAPOL AUTH_PAE state machine was left in incomplete state at the
completion of FT protocol. Set portValid = TRUE to allow the state
machine to proceed from AUTHENTICATING to AUTHENTICATED state, so that a
new EAPOL reauthentication can be triggered.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-19 21:16:06 +02:00
Anton Nayshtut
0603bcb7fe hostapd: Process MAC ACLs on a station association event (SME in driver)
Now hostapd will use station MAC-based permissions according to the
macaddr_acl policy also for drivers which use AP SME offload, but do not
support NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL for offloading MAC ACL processing. It
should be noted that in this type of case the association goes through
and the station gets disconnected immediately after that.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-11-17 12:38:32 +02:00
Frederic Leroy
7b0f5500b0 eap_sim_db: Implement eap_sim_db_expire_pending()
Expire pending DB request for EAP-SIM/AKA/AKA'. Timeout defaults to 1
second and is user configurable in hostapd.conf (eap_sim_db_timeout).

Signed-off-by: Frederic Leroy <frederic.leroy@b-com.com>
2015-10-31 16:28:16 +02:00
Srinivasa Duvvuri
053693d266 hostapd: Add feature to start all interfaces at the same time in sync
When multiple interfaces across mutiple radios are started using a
single instance of hostapd, they all come up at different times
depending upon how long the ACS and HT scan take on each radio. This
will result in stations (that already have the AP profile) associating
with the first interfaces that comes up. For example in a dual band
radio case (2G and 5G) with ACS enabled, 2G always comes up first
because the ACS scan takes less time on 2G and this results in all
stations associating with the 2G interface first.

This feature brings up all the interfaces at the same time. The list of
interfaces specified via hostapd.conf files on the command line are all
marked as sync interfaces. All the interfaces are synchronized in
hostapd_setup_interface_complete().

This feature is turned on with '-S' commmand line option.

Signed-off-by: Srinivasa Duvvuri <sduvvuri@chromium.org>
2015-10-28 19:47:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f88bcad015 GAS server: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1e72ba2e61 RSN auth: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a5a2f252cb AP: Avoid undefined behavior in pointer arithmetic in IE parsing
Reorder terms in a way that no invalid pointers are generated with
pos+len operations. end-pos is always defined (with a valid pos pointer)
while pos+len could end up pointing beyond the end pointer which would
be undefined behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-25 15:34:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1166b20c95 Add Framed-IP-Address to Accounting-Request if STA address is known
The recently added ProxyARP support (proxy_arp=1) in hostapd allows a
STA IPv4 address to be learned from DHCP or ARP messages. If that
information is available, add it to Account-Request messages in
Framed-IP-Address attribute.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-17 19:53:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9b7a1bd7ed Option to reduce Probe Response frame responses during max STA
The new hostapd configuration parameter no_probe_resp_if_max_sta=1 can
be used to request hostapd not to reply to broadcast Probe Request
frames from unassociated STA if there is no room for additional stations
(max_num_sta). This can be used to discourage a STA from trying to
associate with this AP if the association would be rejected due to
maximum STA limit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-10-17 19:30:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
207976f053 Fix Suite B 192-bit AKM to use proper PMK length
In addition to the PTK length increasing, the length of the PMK was
increased (from 256 to 384 bits) for the 00-0f-ac:12 AKM. This part was
missing from the initial implementation and a fixed length (256-bit) PMK
was used for all AKMs.

Fix this by adding more complete support for variable length PMK and use
384 bits from MSK instead of 256 bits when using this AKM. This is not
backwards compatible with the earlier implementations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-14 18:43:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ae7d9fbd3d Remove unreachable PMKSA cache entry addition on Access-Accept
The previous implementation used an obsolete sm->eapol_key_crypt pointer
which was not set anywhere (i.e., was always NULL). In addition, the
condition of sm->eap_if->eapKeyAvailable was not valid here since this
is the case of MSK from an external authentication server and not the
internal EAP server. Consequently, the wpa_auth_pmksa_add() call here
was never used.

The PMKSA cache was still added, but it happened at the completion of
the 4-way handshake rather than at the completion of EAP authentication.
That later location looks better, so delete the unreachable code in
Access-Accept handling. In addition, remove the now complete unused
struct eapol_state_machine eapol_key_* variables.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-14 18:43:26 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1b822f52e6 hostapd: Fix WPA, IEEE 802.1X, and WPS deinit in cases where init fails
With driver wrappers that implement set_privacy(), set_generic_elem(),
set_ieee8021x(), or set_ap_wps_ie(), it was possible to hit a NULL
pointer dereference in error cases where interface setup failed and
the network configuration used WPA/WPA2, IEEE 802.1X, or WPS.

Fix this by skipping the driver operations in case the driver interface
is not initialized.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-14 18:42:07 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
695dbbea88 Interworking: Add support for configuring arbitrary ANQP-elements
The new hostapd configuration parameter anqp_elem can now be used to
configure arbitrary ANQP-elements for the GAS/ANQP server. In addition
to supporting new elements, this can be used to override previously
supported elements if some special values are needed (mainly for testing
purposes).

The parameter uses following format:
anqp_elem=<InfoID>:<hexdump of payload>

For example, AP Geospatial Location ANQP-element with unknown location:
anqp_elem=265:0000
and AP Civic Location ANQP-element with unknown location:
anqp_elem=266:000000

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-10-07 17:07:21 +03:00
Dmitry Ivanov
9b285081ff Wait longer for inactive client probe (empty data frame)
Some devices cannot respond to inactive client probe (empty data frame)
within one second. For example, iPhone may take up to 3 secs. This
becomes a significant problem when ap_max_inactivity is set to lower
value such as 10 secs. iPhone can lose Wi-Fi connection after ~1 min
of user inactivity.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Ivanov <dima@ubnt.com>
2015-10-06 23:09:55 +03:00
Bob Copeland
681753f23c mesh: Generate proper AID for peer
IEEE Std 802.11-2012 13.3.1 states that the AID should be generated on
the local node for each peer. Previously, we were using the peer link ID
(generated by the peer) which may not be unique among all peers. Correct
this by reusing the AP AID generation code.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-10-06 01:27:29 +03:00
Michael Braun
41d621075e Remove WEP support from VLAN
Commit d66dcb0d0b ('WEP: Remove VLAN
support from hostapd') already removed VLAN support for WEP encryption,
so vlan_setup_encryption_dyn() is no longer needed.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2015-10-06 01:27:27 +03:00
Michael Braun
7cebc8e210 Fix init of group state machine for static VLANs
This ensures that group key is set as long as the interface exists.

Additionally, ifconfig_up is needed as wpa_group will enter
FATAL_FAILURE if the interface is still down. Also vlan_remove_dynamic()
is moved after wpa_auth_sta_deinit() so vlan_remove_dynamic() can check
it was the last user of the wpa_group.

Signed-off-by: Michael Braun <michael-dev@fami-braun.de>
2015-10-06 01:25:36 +03:00
Johannes Berg
2b6e121676 hostapd: Add testing option to use only ECSA
Some APs don't include a CSA IE when an ECSA IE is generated,
and mac80211 used to fail following their channel switch. Add
a testing option to hostapd to allow reproducing the behavior.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2015-10-03 21:37:17 +03:00